Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook (Australian Soil and Land Survey Handbooks Series)
Post on 11-Sep-2021
19 Views
Preview:
Transcript
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbookthird edition
The NaTioNal CommiTTee oN Soil aNd TerraiN
the Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook specifies methods and terminology for soil and land surveys. it has been widely used throughout Australia, providing one reference set of definitions for the characterisation of landform, vegetation, land surface, soil and substrate.
the book advocates that a comprehensive suite of land and soil attributes be recorded in a uniform manner. this approach is more useful than the allocation of land or soil to preconceived types or classes.
the third edition includes revised chapters on location and vegetation as well as some new landform elements. these updates have been guided by the national Committee on Soil and terrain, a steering committee comprising representatives from key federal, state and territory land resource assessment agencies.
essential reading for all professionals involved in land resource surveys, this book will also be of value to students and educators in soil science, geography, ecology, agriculture, forestry, resource management, planning, landscape architecture and engineering.
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook is Volume 1 in the Australian Soil and Land Survey Handbook Series. Other volumes currently available in this series are:
Volume 2: Guidelines for Surveying Soil and Land Resources
Volume 4: The Australian Soil Classification
Volume 5: Soil Physical Measurement and Interpretation for Land Evaluation
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field H
andbookThe N
ational Com
mittee on Soil and Terrain
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
THIRD EDITION
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 1 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 2 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
THIRD EDITION
THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE ON SOIL AND TERRAIN
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 3 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
© CSIRO 2009
All rights reserved. Except under the conditions described in the Australian Copyright Act 1968 and subsequent amendments, no part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, duplicating or otherwise, without the prior permission of the copyright owner. Contact CSIRO PUBLISHING for all permission requests.
National Library of Australia Cataloguing-in-Publication entryAustralian soil and land survey field handbook.
3rd ed.
Collingwood, Vic. : CSIRO Publishing, 2009.
9780643093959 (pbk.)
Australian soil and land survey handbooks ; no. 1
Includes index.Bibliography.
Landforms – Australia – Classification – Handbooks, manuals, etc.Soil surveys – Australia – Handbooks, manuals, etc.Land use surveys – Australia – Handbooks, manuals, etc.Vegetation classification – Australia – Handbooks, manuals, etc.
631.4794First edition 1984; Second edition 1990
Published by CSIRO PUBLISHING 150 Oxford Street (PO Box 1139)Collingwood VIC 3066Australia
Telephone: +61 3 9662 7666Local call: 1300 788 000 (Australia only)Fax: +61 3 9662 7555Email: publishing.sales@csiro.auWeb site: www.publish.csiro.au
Front cover image (by Linda Gregory): soil landform elements overlaid on shaded elevation. Data sources: Hook R, McPherson A, Glover M, McKenzie NJ, Aldrick J (2002) Land and soil survey, Simmons Creek Catchment, Walbundrie, NSW; and AAM Geoscan (2001) Airborne laser scanning survey of the Simmons Creek Catchment area, 10 m digital elevation model.
Set in 10/13 Adobe Palatino and Adobe SabonEdited by Alexa CloudCover and text design by James KellyTypeset by Desktop Concepts Pty Ltd, MelbournePrinted in China by 1010 Printing International Ltd
CSIRO PUBLISHING publishes and distributes scientific, technical and health science books, magazines and journals from Australia to a worldwide audience and conducts these activities autonomously from the research activities of the Commonwealth Scientific and Industrial Research Organisation (CSIRO).
The views expressed in this publication are those of the author(s) and do not necessarily represent those of, and should not be attributed to, the publisher or CSIRO.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 4 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
v
CONTENTS
Preface to the first edition xi
Preface to the second edition xiii
Preface to the third edition xiv
Acknowledgements xvii
Purpose and use of handbook J.G. Speight and R.F. Isbell 1Purpose 1
Use 3
The site concept J.G. Speight and R.C. McDonald 5
Location L.J. Gregory, R.C. McDonald and R.F. Isbell 7Method 7
State or Territory 7
Coordinates 7
Topographic map sheet 9
Global Positioning System (GPS) Survey 10
Air photo reference 10
General R.C. McDonald and R.F. Isbell 13Described by 13
Date 13
Annual rainfall 13
Type of site 13
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 5 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
vi
Landform J.G. Speight 15Landform description 15
Description of landform element 17
Landform element key and glossary 31
Description of landform pattern 44
Landform pattern glossary 55
Vegetation R.J. Hnatiuk, R. Thackway and J. Walker 73Overview of the classification 75
Recognising strata 77
Formation (Level 1) 80
Structural formation (Level 2) 88
Broad floristic formation (Level 3) and subdivisions (Levels 4 to 6) 95
Examples of standard classification 102
Wetlands 103
Rainforest 109
Growth stage 120
Condition 120
Land surface R.C. McDonald, R.F. Isbell and J.G. Speight 127Aspect 127
Elevation 127
Drainage height 128
Disturbance of site 128
Microrelief 129
Erosion 133
Aggradation 138
Inundation 138
Coarse fragments 139
Rock outcrop 143
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 6 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Contents
vii
Depth to free water 144
Runoff 144
Soil profile R.C. McDonald and R.F. Isbell 147Type of soil observation 147
Horizons 148
Depth of horizons 156
Depth to R horizon or strongly cemented pan 156
Colour 159
Mottles and other colour patterns 159
Field texture 161
Coarse fragments 170
Structure 171
Fabric 181
Cutans 182
Voids 184
Soil water status 186
Consistence 186
Condition of surface soil when dry 189
Water repellence 191
Pans 192
Segregations of pedogenic origin 195
Effervescence of carbonate in fine earth 198
Field pH 198
Roots 199
Boundaries between horizons 199
Soil water regime 200
Substrate J.G. Speight and R.F. Isbell 205Properties of substrate material 206
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 7 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
viii
Properties of substrate masses 210
Genetic type of substrate masses 216
Glossary of substrate mass genetic types 219
Appendix 1: Soil taxonomic units R.F. Isbell and R.C. McDonald 225
The Australian Soil Classification 225
Soil Taxonomy 227
World Reference Base for soil resources (WRB) 226
References 229
Index 240
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 8 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Correct citation:If reference is made to the Handbook as a whole, give reference as follows:
in textNational Committee on Soil and Terrain (2009)
in referencesNational Committee on Soil and Terrain (2009) ‘Australian soil and land survey field handbook (3rd edn).’ (CSIRO Publishing: Melbourne).
If reference is made to a specific section e.g. Landform, give reference as follows:
in textSpeight (2009)
in referencesSpeight JG (2009) Landform. In ‘Australian soil and land survey field handbook (3rd edn).’ (National Committee on Soil and Terrain) (CSIRO Publishing: Melbourne).
The Handbook was prepared under the auspices of the National Committee on Soil and Terrain with funding and support from CSIRO, the Natural Heritage Trust and the Bureau of Rural Sciences.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 9 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 10 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
xi
PREFACE TO THE FIRST EDITION
The use of a standard terminology for the characterisation of site attributes, such as landform and vegetation, and for the description of soils has obvious benefits for the various organisations in Australia concerned with soil and land survey investigations. Some uniformity in the description of soils has been achieved over the years with the publication of Soil survey manual (Soil Survey Staff 1951), Guidelines for soil description (FAO 1968) and, in Australia, A factual key for the recognition of Australian soils (Northcote 1971).
In 1975 the Standing Committee on Agriculture established a Working Party to enquire into the nature and prosecution of soil surveys in Australia, with the aim of generating a satisfactory degree of uniformity. This Working Party was convened by Dr E.G. Hallsworth, Chairman of the then CSIRO Land Resource Laboratories, and comprised representatives of these laboratories and appropriate State and Commonwealth authorities. The Working Party recommended the formation of a National Soil and Land Survey Committee1; one of its functions would be the production of an Australian soil and land survey handbook, which would set down standards of terminology and methodology for the survey of all components of land resources. In 1976 the Standing Committee on Agriculture considered the Working Party report and requested that an Expert Panel advise further on ways of producing such a handbook. This Expert Panel, convened by Dr E.G. Hallsworth and comprising members of State and Commonwealth authorities, met in April 1977. It proposed that a committee of three should develop interim standards of soil and land classification and mapping capable of general application and produce a handbook of standard terminology and methodology. The members of the committee were R.C. McDonald, R.F. Isbell and J.G. Speight.
It was originally proposed that the committee would devote not less than 12 months full time to the project. This was not possible, and the members have accordingly devoted their available time to producing this Australian soil
1 This was established as a subcommittee of the Standing Committee on Soil Conservation in 1979 and renamed Australian Soil and Land Resources Committee in 1981.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 11 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
xii
and land survey field handbook. J. Walker and M.S. Hopkins were invited to contribute the section on vegetation.
The first draft was based largely on similar handbooks, namely:
Soil survey manual (Soil Survey Staff 1951)Guidelines for soil description (FAO 1968)A factual key for the recognition of Australian soils (Northcote 1971)Soil survey field handbook (Hodgson 1974) for the Soil Survey of England and Walesthe fifth unpublished draft of the revised United States Department of Agriculture Soil survey manualThe Canada Soil Information System (Can SIS) manual for describing soils in the field (Canada Soil Survey Committee 1978).
Because there was considerable divergence of approach (for example, in setting class limits) for many attributes, it was frequently necessary to judge which particular arrangement was most appropriate to Australian conditions.
The first draft was sent for comment to 116 people representing all relevant organisations in Australia. The 87 replies provided a good representation of ideas. The second draft was also widely circulated and attracted a further range of comment.
Because of the diversity of environments and the nature of the organisations concerned with land and soil investigations in Australia, consensus was not possible for some of the attributes discussed in this Handbook. In most such cases the majority view was adopted.
The suggested field observations encompass a range in convenience of measurement and in relevance both to practical problems of land use and the scientific study of land and soil. Progress towards the establishment of a more relevant suite of attributes will depend to a degree on the use of more systematic methods in the recording of field observations, in order to permit the testing of the underlying, often unstated models. Thus, the use of this Handbook may hasten the development of more concise or more relevant field observations than those recommended in it. Such efforts to improve survey techniques must go hand in hand with efforts to discover from the clients their precise needs.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 12 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
xiii
PREFACE TO THE SECOND EDITION
Since the first edition in 1984 the Handbook has been widely used and adopted as a standard throughout Australia. When the publishers suggested a second edition, a request was made to relevant organisations in Australia for comments and possible modifications on the basis of field use. Numerous responses reflect the actual experiences of users since 1984. Some 23 individual replies were received, as well as three comprehensive submissions from the New South Wales Soil Data System Working Group, the New South Wales Department of Agriculture, and the Victorian Department of Conservation, Forests and Lands. The Australian Surveying and Land Information Group, Department of Administrative Services, Canberra gave useful advice on map references. While it was not possible to adopt every suggestion made, the comments have helped to make this second edition much clearer and more consistent. We thank these respondents for their assistance.
In this edition a number of new sections have been added, and some rearrangements have been made to facilitate use. In particular, a much expanded chapter on substrate has been included. This should help cater to the needs of non-agricultural users. Throughout this revised edition we have tried to keep code changes to a minimum.
The use of a standard terminology for the characterisation of landform and vegetation, and for the description of soils, appears to have been of benefit to scientists in Australia concerned with soil and land survey investigations. We believe that there will be an even wider acceptance of this second edition.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 13 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
xiv
PREFACE TO THE THIRD EDITION
The Australian soil and land survey field handbook is a primary reference for soil scientists, ecologists, geomorphologists and students. The Handbook has been a remarkable success. During the last 25 years, consistent data have been collected on vegetation, landform and soils across Australia and the resulting databases are far more comprehensive and useful than would have otherwise been the case. Many field technicians and scientists have learnt their craft with the aid of the Handbook and it continues to sell at a steady rate. However, this success creates several significant challenges.
The Handbook is essentially a measurement system for recording the attributes of landform, vegetation and soil in a semi-quantitative manner and with minimal instrumentation. Measurement systems have changed dramatically in recent years and an account of the most significant developments is provided in the new Guidelines for surveying soil and land resources (McKenzie et al. 2008). For example, digital terrain analysis has replaced some aspects of air photo interpretation and landform classification, and proximal sensing (e.g. soil spectroscopy in the visible through to the mid-infrared range of the electromagnetic spectrum) is starting to replace conventional soil description. These methods will be deployed in routine surveys during the next few years and so a completely new Handbook will be required.
Changes in this EditionAny change to the Handbook forces major overhauls of existing databases and the consequences can be far reaching and expensive. At the same time, the Handbook must reflect current technology otherwise it is destined to become irrelevant.
The National Committee on Soil and Terrain faced these dilemmas when stocks of the Second Edition ran out. We knew that a complete revision of every aspect of the Handbook was needed but that new copies had to be printed immediately. We decided to publish the Third Edition only with changes that could be made with relative ease. The changes are as follows.
Most significant is revision of the vegetation chapter. As vegetation is outside the scope of the National Committee on Soil and Terrain, this
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 14 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Preface to the Third Edition
xv
chapter has been guided instead by the Executive Steering Committee for Australian Vegetation Information (ESCAVI). ESCAVI has endorsed this chapter as guidelines for the collection of site-based data on vegetation in Australia.
The field data collected with these new methods are currently classified, coded and named differently than in the National Vegetation Information System (NVIS) framework (ESCAVI 2003). Starting in 2008, NVIS will progressively be changed to match the classification in this chapter.
Chapter 6 ‘Vegetation’ has been expanded to include wetlands, temperate rainforests, vegetation growth stage and vegetation condition. Other changes include new height classes, an increased number of broad floristic groups, and different codes for some attributes. The terms used to name vegetation units, based on their cover and broad floristic composition (Table 21), have been changed. Details of the rationale for these changes can be found in Hnatiuk et al. (2008).Chapter 3 ‘Location’ has been updated to accommodate GPS survey and datum information. The State and Territory codes have been changed.Chapter 5 ‘Landform’ includes new landform elements, namely: hummocky dune, barchan dune, parabolic dune, linear or longitudinal dune, risecrest, riseslope, residual rise, deflation basin, solution doline, and collapse doline.
Future changesThe Fourth Edition will need to incorporate results from current research and provide guidance on several new technologies. The main challenges apparent at this stage are as follows.
The site concept which forms the basis for landform description will need revision to ensure it is consistent with contemporary methods for digital terrain analysis, spatial analysis and Earth-system science.Gary Speight’s system for measuring and classifying landform was pioneering and many of his ideas have been incorporated into recent methods for digital terrain analysis. A new system for characterising landform is needed that takes full advantage of the new technology while retaining the link to geomorphic processes. This will be a major challenge.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 15 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
xvi
High-resolution digital elevation models and new forms of remote sensing promise to replace the qualitative descriptors of land surface presented in this edition. Extensive testing across a range of environments is needed to identify robust descriptors.As noted earlier, rapid advances in proximal sensing are starting to provide a practical alternative to conventional descriptions of soil morphology. Considerable field testing and further research will be needed before agreement can be reached on a new minimum data set for characterising soil profiles in the field. Database systems will require a major overhaul.Closely related to proximal sensing is the advent of systems for automatic data entry via various forms of telemetry. Again, guidelines are required on data models, minimum data sets and transfer protocols.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 16 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
xvii
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
Acknowledging the many contributors to the Handbook is becoming increasingly difficult. The Handbook is a collective effort and overall authorship now rests with the National Committee on Soil and Terrain. Several of the original authors have retired (Gary Speight, Joe Walker and Mike Hopkins) or sadly died (Ron McDonald and Ray Isbell) since the initial publication in 1984. However, we have retained their names on contributions that remain essentially intact. Joe Walker has also retired but he kindly contributed to the major revision of the vegetation chapter in collaboration with Roger Hnatiuk and Richard Thackway (Bureau of Rural Sciences). Linda Gregory (CSIRO) revised the chapter on site location.
Specific inputs on landform and substrate were provided by David Maschmedt (South Australian Department of Water, Land and Biodiversity Conservation) and Colin Pain (Geoscience Australia). Other members of the National Committee on Soil and Terrain assisted with the production process, most notably Noel Schoknecht (Western Australian Department of Agriculture and Food) and Neil McKenzie (CSIRO). Greg Rinder expertly prepared the figures and David Jacquier helped the editorial team.
Becky Schmidt (CSIRO) provided excellent editorial input to this edition. The team at CSIRO Publishing once again were exceedingly helpful and very patient. Particular thanks go to Tracey Millen, Ted Hamilton and Briana Melideo.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 17 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 18 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
1
PURPOSE AND USE OF HANDBOOK
J.G. Speight and R.F. Isbell
PURPOSEThis Handbook is intended to contribute to the systematic recording of field observations in Australian soil and land surveys. It attempts to:
list attributes2 thought necessary to describe adequately site and soil conditionsdefine these attributes consistently wherever possible with their use elsewhere in the world but giving particular emphasis to Australian conditionsdefine terms and categories for landform, vegetation, land surface, soil and substrate material that are based explicitly on the specified attributessuggest codings for the various attributes, terms and categories so that concise recording systems may be developed for field use.
A further purpose of the Handbook is to provide a factual database from which interpretations can be made. Field observations provide the basis for predicting the consequences of land use. These may be supplemented by data
2 No distinction is made between the word ‘attribute’ and the word ‘property’ used in the Soil Profile section. Both mean ‘characteristic’ or ‘trait’. ‘Attribute’ includes ‘variable’. Observations produce values of attributes or properties.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 1 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
2
from air photos, maps, records, laboratory analyses, experiments, local information and so on. The chain of inference for making such predictions has been clearly established in only a few instances, evidence that perhaps the weakest link is the collection of relevant field data.
This Handbook was prepared to meet the needs of somewhat diverse surveys. The Handbook covers a range of soil surveys, typically at medium and small scales, and ‘land system’, ‘land unit’, ‘biophysical’, ‘ecological’ and ‘environmental impact’ surveys, whether for agricultural, recreational, industrial, residential or other purposes such as a general scientific inventory. The observations proposed are relevant to surveys at diverse scales, although surveys at very large scales commonly demand both more detailed observations, and also observations of particular attributes that probably have not been included here. At such large scales, many attributes of the site that surrounds each point of soil observation may be uniform over most of the points, and thus is of little interest within the context of the given survey. However, if site attributes are recorded for at least a few of the observation points, they may prove extremely valuable in later correlative work.
The recording of attributes of the site and adjacent landforms has two distinct purposes. First, the attributes may be directly relevant to land use – for example, to ploughing feasibility, earthmoving costs, erosion hazards, scenic resources and costs of clearing. Second, the attributes are a link between the hidden physical and chemical properties of the soil, regolith or bedrock, for which data will always be scarce, and the visible properties of landform, surface material, and vegetation that may be more readily mapped and catalogued.
Site attributes link to other attributes both within a site and beyond it. Attributes are intended to be correlated with soil and other subsurface properties observed at the site in order to discover significant relationships between them. Relationships implied in some surveys have lacked adequate support (Bleeker and Speight 1978; Chittleborough 1978). Better validation is required to justify extrapolative mapping and the setting up of land units or land components. The site data, however, are intended to establish local ‘ground truth’ values for the landform, surface material and vegetative properties that contribute to the more extensively developed characteristic image, ‘signature’, or pattern on an air photo or other remote-sensing record.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 2 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Purpose and Use of Handbook
3
USEThe Handbook is designed as a reference to attributes needed to describe systematically the site and soil conditions related to landform, vegetation, land surface, soil profile and substrate materials.
The glossaries and definitions of terms will provide a uniform understanding of the meaning of words used in field notes, in discussion and in publications. This will enhance communication.
The attributes are to form the basis of lists to be used for specific surveys. When developed, these lists will provide sufficient information to support the survey conclusions. For each attribute, there is a suggested scheme of classes, but this does not preclude the observation and recording of actual numerical values where feasible.
Suggested code letters and numbers for each attribute described appear in red.
Not all conceivable soil properties are provided for and hence some properties may need to be recorded, if desired, in free format – for example, orientation of mottles.
All dimensions are expressed in SI units.The attributes to be recorded in a specific survey will depend on its
purpose and scale and will be decided upon by the organisation conducting the survey. In reconnaissance surveys, fewer site and profile attributes will be described than in high-intensity surveys. For detailed site and profile descriptions such as those required for pedological research, descriptions of agronomic research sites or in the legend-making stage of detailed surveys, most of the attributes given in this Handbook will be recorded, if present.
It is important that sites and profiles be described as they are and not as they may have been. Sites and profiles should be described as factually as practicable but genetic inferences are inevitable. Where genetic inferences are used, the basis of the inference should be noted so the user is aware of assumptions made. The field observations are for the descriptions of sites (page 5) and not for soil classes or for aspects of mapping units that are better recorded in the office rather than in the field. Although diagnostic horizons necessary for particular soil classification systems, for instance Soil Taxonomy (Soil Survey Staff 1975), are not included, the field observations recorded may be used to classify soil in this or in any other soil classification scheme. Coding for soil classification schemes most likely to be used in Australia is given in Appendix 1.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 3 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
4
Most of the attributes of soil to be observed, horizon by horizon, are widely accepted among pedologists. However, there are some that do not have direct relevance to land use; rather, they serve as surrogates for properties that are impractical to observe or measure routinely.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 4 4/02/09 12:05:20 PM
5
THE SITE CONCEPTJ.G. Speight and R.C. McDonald
A site is a small area of land considered representative of the landform, vegetation, land surface and other land features associated with the soil observation.
The extent of a site is arbitrary but certain dimensions are appropriate for certain attributes.
Observe landform element attributes over a circle of 20 m radius (1256 m2) and landform pattern attributes over a circle of 300 m radius (28.3 ha). Sample vegetation in a square or rectangular site of 400 m2. In sites dominated by ground layer, several 20–50 m2 samples or 10–20 m transects are used. Observe most land surface attributes within a site 10 m in radius (315 m2); these attributes are: slope, aspect, disturbance of site, microrelief, surface coarse fragments, rock outcrop and runoff. A few land surface attributes refer simply to the point of soil observation, namely elevation, drainage height and depth to free water; the attributes erosion, aggradation and inundation refer to the larger 20 m radius site used for landform element attributes.
In some instances a soil observation may be representative only of a soil body smaller than 10 m in radius. For example, in some gilgai the vegetation, land surface and soil all differ between the mound and depression. In such instances the extent of the site for those features is only that of the mound or the depression.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 5 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 6 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
7
LOCATIONL.J. Gregory, R.C. McDonald and R.F. Isbell
METHODRecord the method used to acquire the coordinates.
R Map referenceG GPSS Survey
STATE OR TERRITORYRecord the code as follows for the State or Territory in which the site is described. These codes have been changed from McDonald and Isbell (1990).
1 NSW 5 WA2 VIC 6 TAS3 QLD 7 NT4 SA 8 ACT
COORDINATESDatumRecord the datum of the coordinates. Older maps will generally be based on the Australian Geodetic Datum of 1966 or 1984 (AGD66, AGD84), while current maps should be based on the Geocentric Datum of Australia (GDA94). If you
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 7 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
8
are obtaining coordinates from a Global Positioning System (GPS) unit, the native datum is the World Geodetic System (WGS84). However, this may not be the display default so check the settings. For further information, see the Geocentric datum of Australia technical manual (Intergovernmental Committee on Surveying and Mapping 2002).
AGD66 Australian Geodetic Datum 1966AGD84 Australian Geodetic Datum 1984GDA94 Geocentric Datum of Australia 1994WGS84 World Geodetic System 1984
ProjectionState whether the coordinates are projected or geographic.
M Projected by Universal Transverse Mercator system L Geographic (latitude and longitude)
ProjectedMost topographic map sheets are projected onto the Universal Transverse Mercator (UTM) coordinate system. In Australia, this will be called the Australian Map Grid (AMG) or the Map Grid of Australia (MGA) depending on the datum used. The easting and northing coordinates taken from these sheets will have 6 digits and 7 digits respectively. The zone will also be required (49–56 in Australia). Do not use the Universal Grid Reference notation.3
GeographicWhen using a GPS or a regional map, record coordinates in latitude and longitude. Record southern hemisphere latitudes as negative.
Easting, northing, zoneRecord easting and northing UTM projected coordinates, when reading from a topographic map. Give a 6-figure easting, a 7-figure northing and a 2-figure grid
3 The Universal Grid Reference (National Mapping Council of Australia 1986) uses a zone designator and 100 000 metre square identification along with a reduced set of digits. The example given in the section ‘Easting, northing, zone’ (see page 9) would be recorded as 55HFA9208494905 (‘55H’ is the zone designator while ‘FA’ is the 100 000 metre square identification).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 8 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Location
9
zone (49–56 in Australia), as accurately as map scale permits. Location of the central point of a site on a map is unlikely to be much more accurate than 1 mm on the map (i.e. 10 m on a 1:10 000 scale map, or 100 m on a 1:100 000 scale map). Example:
Zone Easting Northing
55 692084 6094905
Latitude and longitudeCoordinates may be given in degrees, minutes and seconds (DMS) where a location is read from a small-scale (regional) map. When locating with a GPS, record the coordinates in decimal degrees (DD) to five places to obtain a precision to the metre. Latitudes (giving the north or the south part of the coordinate) will be negative in Australia.Example:
Latitude Longitude
–35.27058 149.11181
TOPOGRAPHIC MAP SHEETGive map sheet details regardless of the method used to obtain the coordinates. This will provide a cross-check for attribute accuracy. At scales larger than 1:100 000, use the numbering system for the State or Territory in which the survey is conducted.
Map scale
1 1:1 000 5 1:25 0002 1:2 500 6 1:50 0003 1:5 000 7 1:100 0004 1:10 000 8 1:250 000
Map sheet number and map sheet nameGive number and name on the map, for example:
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 9 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
10
Map scale 8 7 6Map sheet number SH 50-15 8525 8727-IIIMap sheet name Kellerberrin Kosciuszko Canberra
GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM (GPS) SURVEYRecord the GPS survey method used to obtain the coordinates and estimate the accuracy. Make sure you also record the datum and projection settings in the appropriate section. Submetre accuracy is usually obtained only through the use of differential techniques. Autonomous (single unit) methods can obtain <15 m accuracy under optimal conditions. Understand the limitations of the equipment and the various factors that will affect the accuracy.
GPS method
S Single unit GPSD Differential GPS
Accuracy estimate
1 <1 m2 1–5 m3 5–15 m4 15–30 m5 >30 m
AIR PHOTO REFERENCEFilm numberGive film number on photo, for example:CABC/C/999 or NSW 2719
Run numberGive number of run.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 10 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Location
11
Frame numberGive number of the individual photo.
Site referenceEast (mm)North (mm)
Give position of site on photo in millimetres east from western edge of the photo and north from southern edge. It is strongly recommended that the site should be marked on the air photo by pricking through the print and writing the site number on the back.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 11 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 12 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
13
GENERALR.C. McDonald and R.F. Isbell
DESCRIBED BYGive first three letters of surname and one initial, for example:
NORK for K.H. Northcote
DATEGive date profile described, for example:
23 December 1989, as 231289
ANNUAL RAINFALLGive mean annual rainfall, in millimetres, from nearest recording station or climate surface.
TYPE OF SITE
G Grid siteF Free survey site
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 13 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 14 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
15
LANDFORMJ.G. Speight
LANDFORM DESCRIPTIONThe description of landform in soil and land surveys has several purposes:
it has direct application to land use planningthe description is useful for finding relationships to support the extrapolation of point observationsit helps to predict the land degradation that may follow various land uses.
Also, landform description often permits the reader to identify the part of terrain under discussion.
Landform description and classification have scarcely developed far enough in any country to meet the needs of land use planning (Lynch and Kolenbrander 1981). The scheme that follows is intended to produce a record of observations rather than inferences. Where inference is implied in geomorphological terminology and practice, a clear record of what has been inferred is presented.
In this technique for describing landforms, the whole land surface is viewed as a mosaic of tiles of odd shapes and sizes. To impose order, the mosaic is treated as if the tiles are of two distinct sizes, the larger ones being themselves mosaics of the smaller ones. The larger tiles, more than 600 m across, are called landform patterns. About 40 types of landform pattern are defined. They include,
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 15 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
16
for example, flood plain, dunefield and hills. The smaller tiles, which form mosaics within landform patterns, are about 40 m or more across. These are called landform elements. Among more than 80 defined types of landform element are included, for example, cliff, footslope and valley flat.
Landform elements and landform patterns are described and classified into named types by the values of their landform attributes. Distinct suites of landform attributes relate to landform elements and landform patterns, respectively. Slope and position in a toposequence are key attributes for landform elements. Relief and stream occurrence describe landform patterns.4
Each of these two landform units is an integral part of a land unit defined in the companion handbook Guidelines for surveying soil and land resources (McKenzie et al. 2008). A landform element is the landform part of a land facet, and a landform pattern is the landform part of a land system.
Maps to display units based on landform can show either landform elements or landform patterns. For each map scale, a unit that is narrower than about 3 mm on the map cannot be read easily. Landform patterns have a characteristic dimension of about 600 m. This is the recommended size for sampling the landform pattern to evaluate its attributes. It is also the normal minimum width of a mapped landform pattern. It follows that landform patterns are best shown on a map at 1:200 000 scale. Landform elements, with a characteristic dimension of about 40 m, are best shown at 1:15 000 scale. Table 1 shows which of these two units is more appropriate on maps of various scales.Both landform elements and landform patterns may extend over areas very much larger then their characteristic dimensions.
Since many relationships between landforms and other phenomena occur at the landform element level, this model should be used to describe landform even when the scale dictates that only landform patterns can be mapped. In the field, describe both landform element and landform pattern. In air photo interpretation and mapping, find the proportional occurrence and distribution of landform elements within each landform pattern.
An even smaller sampling area of 10 m radius is convenient for field observation of certain attributes of landform and other features covered in the chapter ‘Land surface’ (page 127); see also ‘The site concept’ (page 5).
4 Landform patterns and landform elements are formally defined in the abstract of Speight (1974) and are discussed in Speight (1976, 1977).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 16 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Landform
17
How much detail?The attributes listed below are those required to distinguish between the types of landform given in the glossaries. The distinctions that have been made routinely in the past are likely to form a sound basis for survey practice.
For tasks where landform is of little concern, a very brief form of description is specified (pages 26 and 46).
Some of the attributes are expressed in grade scales, with classes of even sizes, usually on a logarithmic base. Where more rigorous analysis is feasible, numerical values of attributes should be observed. Various additional attributes capable of precise quantification may be devised.
DESCRIPTION OF LANDFORM ELEMENTA landform element may be described by the following attributes, assessed within a circle of about 20 m radius:
slopemorphological typedimensionsmode of geomorphological activitygeomorphological agent.
These will establish most of the distinctions between landform elements that are implied by their geomorphological names. The glossary of types of landform element occurring in Australia (page 31) refers explicitly to this set
Table 1 Appropriate landform model for mapping at various scales
Map scaleMinimum width of mapping units Appropriate landform model for mapping
1:500 000 1500 m Landform pattern
1:250 000 750 m Landform pattern
1:100 000 300 m Landform pattern
1:50 000 150 m Landform pattern
1:25 000 75 m Landform pattern/landform element
1:10 000 30 m Landform element
1:5 000 15 m Landform element
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 17 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
18
of attributes. A landform element that has been described may thus be assigned a type name. A shorter description consists simply of slope, morphological type, and name (page 26).
SlopeMeans of evaluation of slope
T Tripod-mounted instrument and staff
A Abney level or clinometer and tape
P Contour plan at 1:10 000 or larger scale
E Estimate
Slope valueExpress slope tangent as a percentage using up to three significant figures (e.g. 1%, 2.45%, 9%, 12.5%, 115%). Evaluate the slope over an interval of 20 m, straddling the point of soil observation.
Slope classSlope classes are defined in Table 2. The optional word ‘inclined’ is used to distinguish slope from other attributes, for example ‘gently inclined footslope’ from ‘gently undulating rises’, and ‘moderately inclined hillslope’ from ‘moderately spaced streams’.
The class boundaries given in Table 2, and repeated in Table 4, are simply boundaries that separate slope terms in common use, adjusted to regular logarithmic intervals. They refer neither to observed natural clustering of slope values, since such clustering has not been shown to occur, nor do they relate precisely to boundary criteria for land use, which may change with advancing technology and which vary arbitrarily between organisations.
It may sometimes be advantageous to split each of the classes ‘very gently inclined’, ‘gently inclined’ and ‘moderately inclined’ into two levels, the appropriate boundary values being 1.8%, 5.6% and 18%.
There may also be compelling reasons for using other schemes of slope classes. However, schemes that do not have constant class widths from low to high slope values can lead to problems in subsequent statistical work.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 18 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Landform
19
Always observe and record the slope as precisely as the chosen survey method permits.
The observation should span no less than 20 m (page 17) so as not to be influenced too much by features of the microrelief (page 129) that occur within the landform element.
Morphological typeLandform elements fall into morphological types as sketched in Figure 1. Ten types are distinguished:
Table 2 Definition of slope classes (after Speight 1967, 1971)
SymbolSlope class
Approximate slope valuesDefinitive slope values (altan units)a
Tangent (%) Degrees
Boundary Average Boundary Average
LE Level 0.6 0°20’
1 0°35’ 10.0
VG Very gently inclined
1 1°
3 1°45’ 15.0
GE Gently inclined
6 3°
10 5°45’ 20.0
MO Moderately inclined
20 10°
32 18° 25.0
ST Steep 40 23°
56 30° 27.5
VS Very steep 70 37°
100 45° 30.0
PR Precipitous 170 60°
300 72° 35.0
CL Cliffed 500 80°
a Altan θ = 10 log10 (1000 tan θ) (Young 1972, page 137).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 19 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
20
C Crest
H Hillock
R Ridge
S Simple slope
U Upper slope
M Mid-slope
L Lower slope
F Flat
V Open depression (vale)
D Closed depression
Of these, the types called ‘slope’ are also characterised by their inclination relative to adjacent elements as waxing, waning, maximal or minimal.
Crests and depressions form the highest and lowest parts of the terrain. They are defined as follows:
Crest Landform element that stands above all, or almost all, points in the adjacent terrain. It is characteristically smoothly convex upwards in downslope profile or in contour, or both. The margin of a crest element should be drawn at the limit of observed curvature.
Depression Landform element that stands below all, or almost all, points in the adjacent terrain. A closed depression stands below all such points; an open depression extends at the same elevation, or lower, beyond the locality where it is observed. Many depressions are concave upwards and their margins should be drawn at the limit of observed curvature.
In any terrain, one may draw slope lines at right angles to the contour lines. Slope lines control the direction of many land-forming processes. In a terrain that has relief (page 45), each slope line runs from the extreme top (summit) of a crest down to the extreme bottom (lowest point) of a closed depression (Cayley 1859). Figure 2a shows many slope lines descending from several summits to one low point. The sequence of landform elements down a slope line is called
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 20 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Landform
21
a toposequence. The position in a toposequence is used to define the morphological types of a slope element that may occur between a crest and a depression. First, the general type is defined:
Slope planar landform element that is neither a crest nor a depression and has an inclination greater than about 1%.
Landform elements that are slopes are treated as if each element is straight, and meets another slope element at a slope break (see Figure 1). Four morphological types are distinguished on their position in a toposequence relative to crests, flats (defined below) and depressions:
Simple slope slope element adjacent below a crest or flat and adjacent above a flat or depression.
Upper slope slope element adjacent below a crest or flat but not adjacent above a flat or depression.
Mid-slope slope element not adjacent below a crest or flat and not adjacent above a flat or depression.
Lower slope slope element not adjacent below a crest or flat but adjacent above a flat or depression.
A toposequence may include no slope element (Figures 1a, c, d), one simple slope (Figures 1b, f, g, h), or an upper slope and a lower slope (Figure 1i). All three cases occur in the area mapped in Figure 2b. More complex toposequences may include an upper slope, a lower slope and one or more mid-slopes (Figures 1e, j). The number of slope elements to distinguish depends either on the chosen level of survey detail or on observed differences in landform and their relationship to soil or vegetation.
Relative inclination of slope elementsAlthough lower slopes are often gentler than upper slopes, they need not be so (Figure 1i). A separate morphological attribute expresses the relative inclination of adjacent landform elements in a toposequence. (Crests and depressions are taken to be gentler than adjacent slopes.)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 21 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
22
X Waxing element upslope is gentler, element downslope is steeper.
N Waning element upslope is steeper, element downslope is gentler.
A Maximal element upslope is gentler, element downslope is gentler.
I Minimal element upslope is steeper, element downslope is steeper.
The morphological types upper slope, mid-slope and lower slope require two codes (e.g. UX, MN) (Figure 1) to include relative inclination. Other morphological types need no second code letter. Simple slopes are always maximal; for crests, flats, depressions, hillocks and ridges, relative inclination does not have a clear meaning.
Flats are not included in the above morphological types. They are defined as follows:
Flat planar landform element that is neither a crest nor a depression and is level or very gently inclined (<3% tangent approximately).
As defined, some flats and slopes may have the same inclination (1–3%). They differ in their typical relation to slope lines and toposequences. The slope line on a flat often runs parallel to the course line in a nearby open depression such as a stream channel. The slope line on a slope seldom does so, but makes an angle with the course line (Figure 2a). A slope typically occurs in a toposequence from a crest to a depression. Where a flat occurs in such a toposequence (Figures 1b, e, h), it usually marks a change in process and a sharp change in the direction of the slope line. Most flats are in terrain with very little relief where crests do not occur.
Compound morphological typesSeveral types of landform feature have crests and adjoining slopes that are so small that a 20 m radius site would usually include both. Two compound morphological types are distinguished by the relative length of the crest:
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 22 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Landform
23
(a)
CrestC
Opendepression
VOpendepressionV
(f)
CrestC
(b)
CrestC
Opendepression
V
FlatF
FlatF
FlatF
FlatF
Simpleslope
S
Simpleslope
S
Simpleslope
S
SimpleslopeS(g)
CrestC
V
Opendepression
(c)
RidgeR
RidgeR
Opendepression
V (h)
CrestC
(d)
(e)
(i)
(j)
CrestC
V
Open depression
VOpen
depression
CrestC
Opendepression
V
Maximalupper slope
UA
Waningmid-slopeMN
Waxingupper slopeUX
Waninglower slope
LN
Maximallower slopeLA
Maximallower slopeLA
Maximalupper slopeUA Minimal
mid-slopeMI
CrestC
Figure 1 Examples of profiles across terrain divided into morphological types of landform element. Note that the boundary between crest and slope elements is at the end of the curvature of the crest. Each slope element is treated as if it were straight.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 23 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
24
900
89087
0
880
890
900
900
SUMMIT
LOWPOINT
SUMMIT
PASS
PASS
PASS
0 100Metres
Ridge Line
Course Line
Other slope lines
SUMMIT
Figure 2a Slope lines overlaid on a contour map to show ridge lines and course lines where many slope lines come together.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 24 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Landform
25
900
89087
0
880
890
900
900
Simple slope
Open
Clo
sed
Simple slopeWaning
lower slope
Maximalupper slope
SIZE OF SITEFOR LANDFORM
ELEMENT
Crest
Crest
Crest
Ope
n de
pres
sion
Crest
depression
depr
essi
on40m
0 100Metres
Figure 2b A landform pattern of rolling low hills mapped into morphological types of landform element. Note that the crests and depressions in this case are mainly narrower than the recommended site size.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 25 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
26
Hillock compound landform element comprising a narrow crest and short adjoining slopes, the crest length being less than the width of the landform element.
Ridge compound landform element comprising a narrow crest and short adjoining slopes, the crest length being greater than the width of the landform element.
A dune is defined in the glossary as a hillock or ridge but, to allow for large dunes or detailed work, elements called dunecrest and duneslope are also defined. Other types of hillock and ridge may be divided into crest and slope elements if necessary.
VisualisationWhen selecting a field site, visualise the set of morphological types of landform element that make up the landform pattern at that place. This includes placing boundaries between the elements. Then the site, or sites, can be properly located. Figure 2b shows an example of morphological types of landform element delineated in rolling low hills.
Short description of a landform elementSlope class, morphological type, and a name from the glossary form the briefest description that is likely to be useful. Examples follow:
Gentle crest: summit surface GE C SUS
Gentle waxing upper slope: (no name) GE UX
Precipitous maximal mid-slope: scarp PR MA SCA
Steep waning lower slope: cliff-footslope ST LN CFS
Gentle waning lower slope: footslope GE LN FOO
Very steep maximal lower slope: (no name) VS LA
Very gentle open depression: drainage depression VG V DDE
Moderate hillock: tor MO H TOR
Level ridge: levee LE R LEV
Very gentle flat: valley flat VG F VLF
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 26 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Landform
27
In each case, the name of the landform element type implies that other, unstated attributes have been observed or inferred. These other attributes are given below. Their values are stated in the glossary of landform elements and in the key (Table 4).
DimensionsAn occurrence of a landform element extends as far as its attributes remain constant. Its dimensions, which may be much greater than the specified sample area diameter of 40 m, can be significant to land use. Terms referring to dimension appear often in the definitions of landform element types. Three dimensions are distinguished, each to be expressed in metres:
Length horizontal distance between the upper and lower margins of the element, measured down a slope line. For crests, the slope line to be used is the ridge line; for depressions, the course line (see Figure 2a). By this definition, many crests and open depressions become very long.
Width horizontal distance between the lateral margins of the element, measured perpendicularly to the length.
Height difference in elevation between the upper and lower margins of (or depth) the element, measured along any slope line. Height can mean
different things and must be carefully defined. For crests, ridges and hillocks, define the upper margin as the point where the selected slope line coalesces with others to form the ridge line. For depressions, define the lower margin as the point where the selected slope line coalesces with others to form the course line.
Location within the landform elementA site chosen to represent a landform element will often be placed centrally within it. For various reasons, a site may not be centrally placed and this should be recorded. The vertical position of the site within the height of the landform element may be the best measure:
T Top third of the height of the landform element
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 27 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
28
M Middle third of the height of the landform element
B Bottom third of the height of the landform element
Location within a toposequenceFor detailed work, the location of the site within the toposequence down a slope line may relate to landform processes. Unfortunately, slope lines, by definition, extend from a summit to the lowest point (Cayley 1859), which may be many kilometres apart. One must arbitrarily determine the effective top and bottom of the toposequence. These effective end points come where the slope line coalesces with other slope lines to form a ridge line or a course line5 (Figure 2a). In practice, ridge lines and course lines are excluded from the toposequence (see height in ‘Dimensions’, page 27). One arbitrary rule that will exclude the ridge line is to put the top of the toposequence where the contour curvature exceeds 60º in 40 m. The course line may be excluded by the same rule, or by putting the bottom of the toposequence at a stream channel.
Any site can be located by its vertical and horizontal distances from the defined top and bottom of the toposequence. Drainage height (page 128) is one of these measures.
The toposequence concept leads to the definition of the attributes specific catchment area and specific dispersal area (Speight 1974, 1980) that predict hillslope hydrology and erosion (see, for example, Moore et al. 1988).
Landform genesisThe two following sections on geomorphological modes and agents refer to the inferred genesis of a landform element. This genesis may have spanned thousands of years. Changes, such as erosion and aggradation, produced by current land use are assessed separately as attributes of the land surface (pages 133–8).
To think clearly about the origin of a landform, one should ask two questions: ‘Which agent formed it?’ and ‘What was the mode of activity of that agent?’
Landforms created by different agents, such as wind, creep and stream flow, may result from the same mode of geomorphological activity (e.g.
5 To define ridge lines and course lines by slope line coalescence, as shown in Figure 2a, departs from Cayley’s concept. He defined them as those slope lines that intersect at a knot (i.e. a pass).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 28 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Landform
29
erosion). Those created by the same agent may differ according to whether the mode of activity builds them up or breaks them down.
Mode of geomorphological activityVarious modes of geomorphological activity may be distinguished (Figure 3).Gradational activity:
ER Eroded
EA Eroded or aggraded
AG Aggraded
Anti-gradational activity:
HU Heaved up or elevated
BU Built up
EX Excavated or dug out
SU Subsided or depressed
Gradational activities are those that tend to reduce the land to a common elevation by removing material from higher places and depositing it in lower places (Chamberlin and Salisbury 1904, page 2), without necessarily reducing the angle of slope at every point. The work of streams and landslides is almost entirely in the gradational modes. However, this tendency is opposed by many processes that commonly act in an anti-gradational mode. These modes are characteristic of volcanism, diastrophism and various kinds of human and biological activity.
However, many engineering works involve erosion and aggradation because these gradational modes use less energy than anti-gradational modes. For the same reason, erosion and aggradation may easily be induced unintentionally by land use (pages 133–8).
To judge the mode of geomorphological activity responsible for a given landform element, the observer must visualise a former surface that has suffered distortion, burial or removal of material, and seek evidence that such activity has taken place. (Information on soil and substrate materials relevant to this investigation should be recorded as specified in other sections.)
Allow for the recording of more than one mode of activity, together with options concerning geomorphological agents.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 29 4/02/09 12:05:21 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
30
Geomorphological agentGeomorphological agents that help produce distinctive landform elements are listed in Table 3.
Much of the standard terminology relevant to landform elements presumes that the geomorphological agent responsible for a landform is known; this presumption is incorporated explicitly in the following glossary ‘Landform element key and glossary’. In practice, the observer may find it difficult to infer the agent responsible for producing a given landform element correctly. The problem may be compounded by the apparent significance of more than one agent. In such cases, the observer should record both (a) the dominant agent, or the agent that is confidently inferred; and (b) a subordinate agent, or an agent that is dubiously inferred. In dubious cases, leave category (a) blank.
The importance of identifying landform elements with the agent channelled stream flow is discussed under ‘Channel depth relative to width’ on page 49.
Underlying materialsWhile inferences about geomorphological agents and their mode of activity are essential to define many types of landform element (and landform pattern), observations of the underlying materials are not. Since these materials are often inaccessible to the observer, they should not be definitive for landforms. Landforms are seen as indicators of the underlying materials, permitting their
ERODED ERODED orAGGRADED
HEAVED UPor
ELEVATED
EXCAVATEDor
DUG OUT
SUBSIDEDor
DEPRESSED
BUILT UP
AGGRADED
GRADATIONAL
ANTI-GRADATIONAL
Figure 3 Modes of geomorphological activity.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 30 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
31
extrapolation from limited exposures. The description of bedrock and regolith is discussed in the chapter ‘Substrate’ on page 205.
LANDFORM ELEMENT KEY AND GLOSSARYThe glossary below aims to provide an adequate, concise set of names for types of landform element. Where different landform elements in a survey
Table 3 Geomorphological agents significant for definition of landform elements and landform patterns
Gravity
GR Collapse, or particle fall
Precipitation
SO SM WM SH
Solution Soil moisture status changes; creep Water-aided mass movements; landslides Sheet flow, sheet wash, surface wash
Stream flow
OV CH
Overbank stream flow, unchannelled Channelled stream flow
Wind
WI Wind
Ice
FR GL
Frost, including freeze–thaw Glacier flow
Standing water
WA TI EU
Waves Tides Eustasy; changes in sea level
Internal forces
DI VO
Diastrophism; earth movements Volcanism
Biological agents
BI HU
Non-human biological agents; coral Human agents
Extraterrestrial agents
IM Impact by meteors
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 31 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
32
area have the same type name, distinguish them by qualifying terms based on attributes of landform element or of land surface. Examples are:
steep maximal upper hillsloperocky, gentle upper hillslopeseverely gullied footslope.
Each glossary definition is based on the attributes that have been listed. Table 4 is a key for finding the name of a landform element, the attributes of which have been evaluated. Attribute values that have not been observed but merely inferred from a glossary definition must not be treated as data.
Glossary
ALC Alcove moderately inclined to very steep, short open depression with concave cross-section, eroded by collapse, landslides, creep or surface wash.
BKP Backplain large flat resulting from aggradation by overbank stream flow at some distance from the stream channel and in some cases biological (peat) accumulation; often characterised by a high watertable and the presence of swamps or lakes; part of a covered plain landform pattern.
BAN Bank very short, very wide slope, moderately inclined to (stream precipitous, forming the marginal upper parts of a stream bank) channel and resulting from erosion or aggradation by
channelled stream flow.
BAR Bar elongated, gently to moderately inclined, low ridge (stream bar) built up by channelled stream flow; part of a stream bed.
DUB Barchan crescent-shaped dune with tips extending leeward dune (downwind), making this side concave and the
windward (upwind) side convex. Barchan dunes tend to be arranged in chains extending in the dominant wind direction.
BEA Beach short, low, very wide slope, gently or moderately inclined, built up or eroded by waves, forming the shore of a lake or sea.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 32 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
33
BRI Beach ridge very long, nearly straight, low ridge, built up by waves and usually modified by wind. A beach ridge is often a relict feature remote from the beach.
BEN Bench short, gently or very gently inclined minimal mid-slope element eroded or aggraded by any agent.
BER Berm (i) short, very gently inclined to level minimal mid-slope in an embankment or cut face, eroded or aggraded by human activity. (ii) flat built up by waves above a beach.
BOU Blow-out usually small, open or closed depression excavated by the wind.
BRK Breakaway steep maximal mid-slope or upper slope, generally comprising both a very short scarp (free face) that is often bare rockland, and a stony scarp-footslope (debris slope); often standing above a pediment.
Channel see Stream channel.
CBE Channel flat at the margin of a stream channel aggraded and bench partly eroded by overbank and channelled stream flow;
an incipient flood plain. Channel benches have been referred to as ‘low terraces’, but the term ‘terrace’ should be restricted to landform patterns above the influence of active stream flow.
CIR Cirque precipitous to gently inclined, typically closed depression of concave contour and profile excavated by ice. The closed part of the depression may be shallow, the larger part being an open depression like an alcove.
CLI Cliff very wide, cliffed (greater than 72º) maximal slope usually eroded by gravitational fall as a result of erosion of the base by various agencies; sometimes built up by marine organisms (cf. Scarp).
CFS Cliff- slope situated below a cliff, with its contours generally footslope parallel to the line of the cliff, eroded by sheet wash or
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 33 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
34
Tabl
e 4
Key
to la
ndfo
rm e
lem
ent t
ypes
Mor
phol
ogic
al t
ype
Mod
e of
act
ivit
yLa
nd-f
orm
ing
agen
tO
ther
dis
crim
inat
ors
Land
form
ele
men
t ty
pe
Nam
eC
ode
Nam
eC
ode
Cre
stC
Erod
edC
reep
or
shee
t was
hN
ot v
ery
wid
e,
stee
per
Hill
cres
tH
CR
Ver
y w
ide,
gen
tler
Sum
mit
surf
ace
SU
SEr
oded
Win
dN
ot v
ery
wid
e, g
entle
rR
isec
rest
RE
CB
uilt
up o
r er
oded
Win
dD
unec
rest
DU
CH
illoc
kH
Erod
edC
reep
or
shee
t was
hW
ith b
are
rock
Tor
TO
RR
egol
ith-c
over
edR
esid
ual r
ise
RE
RH
eave
d up
Vol
cani
smTu
mul
usT
UM
Bui
lt up
or
erod
edW
ind
(see
als
o R
idge
)D
unea
DU
NW
eakl
y or
ient
edH
umm
ocky
dun
eD
UH
Cre
scen
ticB
arch
an d
une
DU
BPa
rabo
licPa
rabo
lic d
une
DU
PLo
ngitu
dina
lLi
near
or
long
itudi
nal
(sei
f) d
une
DU
F
Vol
cani
smC
one
(vol
cani
c)C
ON
Peop
leM
ound
MO
UR
idge
RB
uilt
up o
r er
oded
Ove
rban
k flo
wLe
vee
LE
VC
hann
el fl
owB
ar (s
trea
m)
BA
RR
elic
t bar
Scro
llS
CR
Cha
nnel
or
over
bank
flo
wR
elic
t lev
ee e
tc.
Prio
r st
ream
PS
T
Win
d(s
ee a
lso
Hill
ock)
Dun
eaD
UN
Win
dFr
om a
djac
ent b
each
Fore
dune
FOR
From
adj
acen
t pla
yaLu
nette
LU
NW
ind
or w
aves
From
bea
ch; r
elic
tB
each
rid
geB
RI
Peop
le(s
ee a
lso
Slop
e)Em
bank
men
taE
MB
To e
nclo
se a
de
pres
sion
Dam
DA
M
Slop
e (u
nspe
cifie
d:
uppe
r, m
id-s
lope
, lo
wer
, or
sim
ple)
S, U
, M,
LEr
oded
Col
laps
eC
liffe
d, v
ery
wid
e,
max
imal
Clif
fC
LI
C
olla
pse,
land
slid
e or
sh
eet w
ash
Prec
ipito
us, v
ery
wid
e, m
axim
alSc
arp
SC
A
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 34 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
35
Mor
phol
ogic
al t
ype
Mod
e of
act
ivit
yLa
nd-f
orm
ing
agen
tO
ther
dis
crim
inat
ors
Land
form
ele
men
t ty
pe
Nam
eC
ode
Nam
eC
ode
Slop
e (u
nspe
cifie
d)
(con
t.)Sh
eet w
ash,
cre
ep o
r la
ndsl
ide
Hill
slop
eH
SL
Peop
leC
ut fa
ceC
UT
Erod
ed a
nd
aggr
aded
Land
slid
eH
umm
ocky
Land
slid
eL
DS
Bui
lt up
Peop
le(s
ee a
lso
Rid
ge)
Emba
nkm
enta
EM
BSi
mpl
e sl
ope
SEr
oded
or
aggr
aded
Cha
nnel
flow
Ban
k (s
trea
m)
BA
NB
uilt
up o
r er
oded
Wav
esV
ery
wid
eB
each
BE
AW
ind
Dun
eslo
peD
US
Cre
ep o
r sh
eet w
ash
Min
imal
slo
peR
ises
lope
RE
SM
id-s
lope
MEr
oded
Col
laps
e, la
ndsl
ide
or
shee
t was
hSm
all s
carp
and
sc
arp-
foot
slop
e to
geth
er
Bre
akaw
ayB
RK
Land
slid
e or
she
et
was
hA
t foo
t of a
clif
f (se
e al
so L
ower
slo
pe)
Clif
f-fo
otsl
opea
CF
S
Cre
ep o
r sh
eet w
ash
At f
oot o
f a s
carp
(see
al
so L
ower
slo
pe)
Scar
p-fo
otsl
opea
SF
S
Erod
ed o
r ag
grad
edA
ny a
gent
Min
imal
slo
peB
ench
BE
NPe
ople
Min
imal
slo
peB
erm
(i)
BE
RLo
wer
slo
peL
Erod
edLa
ndsl
ide
or s
heet
w
ash
At f
oot o
f a c
liff (
see
also
Mid
-slo
pe)
Clif
f-fo
otsl
opea
CF
S
Cre
ep o
r sh
eet w
ash
At f
oot o
f a s
carp
(see
al
so M
id-s
lope
)Sc
arp-
foot
slop
eaS
FS
Erod
ed o
r ag
grad
edSh
eet w
ash
Larg
e, g
entle
, mai
nly
erod
ed (s
ee a
lso
Flat
)Pe
dim
enta
PE
D
Shee
t was
h, la
ndsl
ide
or c
reep
Wan
ing
slop
e, n
ot
larg
eFo
otsl
ope
FOO
Agg
rade
dC
olla
pse
Roc
k fr
agm
ents
Talu
sTA
LM
ainl
y fo
rmed
by
eros
ion;
agg
rada
tion
is
loca
l
Clif
f-fo
otsl
opea
CF
S
Flat
FA
ny m
ode
Any
age
ntLa
rge,
gen
tle, m
ainl
y er
oded
(see
als
o Fl
at)
Plai
nP
LA
Erod
edSh
eet w
ash
Roc
kR
ock
flat
RF
LW
aves
Roc
kR
ock
plat
form
RP
L
a La
ndfo
rm e
lem
ent t
ype
nam
e oc
curs
mor
e th
an o
nce.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 35 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
36
Mor
phol
ogic
al t
ype
Mod
e of
act
ivit
yLa
nd-f
orm
ing
agen
tO
ther
dis
crim
inat
ors
Land
form
ele
men
t ty
pe
Nam
eC
ode
Nam
eC
ode
Flat
(con
t.)F
Peop
leC
ut-o
ver
surf
ace
CO
SEr
oded
or
dug
out
Win
d or
she
et w
ash
Soil-
erod
ed, s
mal
lSc
ald
SC
DEr
oded
or
aggr
aded
Shee
t was
hLa
rge,
gen
tle,
unid
irec
tiona
l, m
ainl
y er
oded
(see
als
o Lo
wer
slo
pe)
Pedi
men
taP
ED
Erod
ed o
r ag
grad
edC
hann
el fl
owR
adia
l, m
ainl
y ag
grad
edFa
nFA
N
Cha
nnel
or
over
bank
flo
wEn
clos
ed b
y sl
opes
, m
ainl
y ag
grad
edV
alle
y fla
tV
LF
Rel
ict,
smal
lTe
rrac
e fla
tT
EF
At c
hann
el m
argi
n,
smal
lC
hann
el b
ench
CB
E
Agg
rade
dO
verb
ank
flow
Larg
eB
ackp
lain
BK
PC
hann
el fl
owLa
rge
Scro
ll pl
ain
SR
PC
hann
el o
r ov
erba
nk
flow
Rad
ial,
on a
floo
d pl
ain
Floo
d-ou
tF
LD
Rel
ict,
larg
eTe
rrac
e pl
ain
TE
PTi
des
Und
iffer
entia
ted
Tida
l fla
tT
DF
Freq
uent
ly in
unda
ted
Inte
rtid
al fl
atIT
FSe
ldom
inun
date
dSu
prat
idal
flat
ST
FPe
ople
Fill-
top
FIL
Bui
lt up
Wav
esA
bove
a b
each
Ber
m (i
i)B
ER
Cor
alR
eef f
lat
RE
FO
pen
depr
essi
onV
Erod
edLa
ndsl
ide,
cre
ep o
r su
rfac
e w
ash
Slop
ing,
sho
rtA
lcov
eA
LC
Cha
nnel
flow
and
co
llaps
eW
ith p
reci
pito
us w
alls
Gul
lyG
UL
Gla
cier
flow
Part
dug
out
and
cl
osed
dep
ress
ion
Cir
quea
CIR
Erod
ed o
r ag
grad
edSh
eet w
ash
Gen
tle o
r fla
t, lo
ngD
rain
age
depr
essi
onD
DE
Erod
ed, a
ggra
ded,
du
g ou
t or
built
up
Cha
nnel
flow
Stre
am c
hann
elS
TC
Mai
nly
erod
ed; p
art o
f st
ream
cha
nnel
Stre
am b
edS
TB
Tabl
e 4
(con
t.)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 36 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
37
Mor
phol
ogic
al t
ype
Mod
e of
act
ivit
yLa
nd-f
orm
ing
agen
tO
ther
dis
crim
inat
ors
Land
form
ele
men
t ty
pe
Nam
eC
ode
Nam
eC
ode
Ope
n de
pres
sion
(con
t.)C
hann
el fl
ow a
nd ti
des
Tape
red;
tide
wat
er
only
Tida
l cre
ekT
DC
Tape
red;
riv
er a
nd
tide
wat
erEs
tuar
yE
ST
Agg
rade
dO
verb
ank
flow
(etc
.)Fl
at; s
urfa
ce
wat
erta
ble
(see
als
o C
lose
d de
pres
sion
)
Swam
paS
WP
Cha
nnel
flow
Bet
wee
n sc
rolls
Swal
e (ii
)S
WL
Bui
lt up
or
dug
out
Win
d or
wav
esB
etw
een
ridg
esSw
ale
(i)S
WL
Dug
out
Peop
leTr
ench
TR
EC
lose
d de
pres
sion
DA
ny m
ode
Any
age
ntLa
rge,
wat
er-f
illed
Lake
LA
KLa
rge,
usu
ally
dri
ed
upPl
aya
PLY
Erod
edW
ind
Def
latio
n ba
sin
DB
ASo
lutio
nSo
lutio
n do
line
DO
LC
olla
pse
Col
laps
e do
line
DO
CC
hann
el fl
owLo
ng, c
urve
dO
x-bo
wO
XB
Agg
rade
dW
aves
or
cora
lLa
rge,
sal
twat
er-f
illed
Lago
onL
AG
Ove
rban
k flo
w o
r pe
atSu
rfac
e w
ater
tabl
e (s
ee a
lso
Ope
n de
pres
sion
)
Swam
paS
WP
Dug
out
Win
dSm
all
Blow
-out
BO
UG
laci
er fl
owPa
rtly
ero
ded
open
de
pres
sion
Cir
quea
CIR
Vol
cani
smU
sual
ly w
ater
-fill
edM
aar
MA
AV
olca
nism
, met
eor
or
peop
leB
y ex
plos
ion
Cra
ter
CR
A
Peop
lePi
tP
IT
a La
ndfo
rm e
lem
ent t
ype
nam
e oc
curs
mor
e th
an o
nce.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 37 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
38
water-aided mass movement, and aggraded locally by collapsed material from above.
DOC Collapse steep-sided, circular or elliptical closed depression, doline commonly funnel-shaped, characterised by subsurface
drainage and formed by collapse of underlying caves within bedrock.
CON Cone hillock with a circular symmetry built up by (volcanic) volcanism. The crest may form a ring around a crater.
CRA Crater steep to precipitous closed depression excavated by explosions due to volcanism, human action, or impact of an extraterrestrial object.
CUT Cut face slope eroded by human activity.
COS Cut-over flat eroded by human activity. surface
DAM Dam ridge built up by human activity so as to close a depression.
DBA Deflation basin excavated by wind erosion which removes loose basin material, commonly above a resistant or wet layer.
DDE Drainage level to gently inclined, long, narrow, shallow open depression depression with smoothly concave cross-section, rising
to moderately inclined side slopes, eroded or aggraded by sheet wash.
DUN Dune moderately inclined to very steep ridge or hillock built up by the wind. This element may comprise dunecrest and duneslope.
DUC Dunecrest crest built up or eroded by the wind (see Dune).
DUS Duneslope slope built up or eroded by the wind (see Dune).
EMB Embank- ridge or slope built up by human activity. ment
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 38 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
39
EST Estuary stream channel close to its junction with a sea or lake, where the action of channelled stream flow is modified by tide and waves. The width typically increases downstream.
FAN Fan large, gently inclined to level element with radial slope lines inclined away from a point, resulting from aggradation, or occasionally from erosion, by channelled, often braided, stream flow, or possibly by sheet flow.
FIL Fill-top flat aggraded by human activity.
FLD Flood-out flat inclined radially away from a point on the margin or at the end of a stream channel, aggraded by overbank stream flow, or by channelled stream flow associated with channels developed within the overbank flow; part of a covered plain landform pattern.
FOO Footslope moderately to very gently inclined waning lower slope resulting from aggradation or erosion by sheet flow, earth flow or creep (cf. Pediment).
FOR Foredune very long, nearly straight, moderately inclined to very steep ridge built up by the wind from material from an adjacent beach.
GUL Gully open depression with short, precipitous walls and moderately inclined to very gently inclined floor or small stream channel, eroded by channelled stream flow and consequent collapse and water-aided mass movement.
HCR Hillcrest very gently inclined to steep crest, smoothly convex, eroded mainly by creep and sheet wash. A typical element of mountains, hills, low hills and rises.
HSL Hillslope gently inclined to precipitous slope, commonly simple and maximal, eroded by sheet wash, creep or water-aided mass movement. A typical element of mountains, hills, low hills and rises.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 39 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
40
DUH Hummocky very gently to moderately inclined rises or hillocks (weakly built up or eroded by wind and lacking distinct oriented) orientation or regular pattern. dune
ITF Intertidal see Tidal flat. flat
LAG Lagoon closed depression filled with water that is typically salt or brackish, bounded at least in part by forms aggraded or built up by waves or reef-building organisms.
LAK Lake large, water-filled closed depression.
LDS Landslide moderately inclined to very steep slope, eroded in the upper part and aggraded in the lower part by water-aided mass movement, characterised by irregular hummocks.
LEV Levee very long, low, narrow, nearly level, sinuous ridge immediately adjacent to a stream channel, built up by overbank flow. Levees are built, usually in pairs bounding the two sides of a stream channel, at the level reached by frequent floods. This element is part of a covered plain landform pattern. For an artificial levee, use Embankment. See also Prior stream.
DUF Linear or large, sharp-crested, elongated, longitudinal (linear) longitudinal dune or chain of sand dunes, oriented parallel, rather (seif) dune than transverse (perpendicular), to the prevailing wind.
(Not to be confused with the trailing arms of parabolic dunes.)
LUN Lunette elongated, gently curved, low ridge built up by wind on the margin of a playa, typically with a moderate, wave-modified slope towards the playa and a gentle outer slope.
MAA Maar level-floored, commonly water-filled closed depression with a nearly circular, steep rim, excavated by volcanism.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 40 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
41
MOU Mound hillock built up by human activity.
OXB Ox-bow long, curved, commonly water-filled closed depression eroded by channelled stream flow but closed as a result of aggradation by channelled or overbank stream flow during the formation of a meander plain landform pattern. The floor of an ox-bow may be more or less aggraded by overbank stream flow, wind, and biological (peat) accumulation.
Pan see Playa.
DUP Parabolic sand dune with a long, scoop-shaped form, convex in dune the downwind direction so that its horns point upwind,
whose ground plan approximates the form of a parabola. The dunes left behind can be referred to as trailing arms. Where many such dunes have traversed an area, these can give the appearance of linear dunes.
PED Pediment large, gently inclined to level (<1%) waning lower slope, with slope lines inclined in a single direction, or somewhat convergent or divergent, eroded or sometimes slightly aggraded by sheet flow (cf. Footslope). It is underlain by bedrock.
PIT Pit closed depression excavated by human activity.
PLA Plain large, very gently inclined or level element, of unspecified geomorphological agent or mode of activity.
PLY Playa large, shallow, level-floored closed depression, intermittently water-filled, but mainly dry due to evaporation, bounded as a rule by flats aggraded by sheet flow and channelled stream flow.
PST Prior long, generally sinuous, low ridge built up from stream materials originally deposited by stream flow along the
line of a former stream channel. The landform element may include a depression marking the old stream bed, and relict levees.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 41 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
42
REF Reef flat flat built up to sea level by marine organisms.
RER Residual hillock of very low to extremely low relief (<30 m) and rise very gentle to steep slopes. This term is used to refer to
an isolated rise surrounded by other landforms.
REC Risecrest crest of hillock of very low to extremely low relief (<30 m) (see Residual rise).
RES Riseslope slope of hillock of very low to extremely low relief (<30 m) (see Residual rise).
RFL Rock flat flat of bare consolidated rock, usually eroded by sheet wash.
RPL Rock flat of consolidated rock eroded by waves. platform
SCD Scald flat, bare of vegetation, from which soil has been eroded or excavated by surface wash or wind.
SCA Scarp very wide, steep to precipitous maximal slope eroded by gravity, water-aided mass movement or sheet flow (cf. Cliff).
SFS Scarp- waning or minimal slope situated below a scarp, with footslope its contours generally parallel to the line of the scarp.
SCR Scroll long, curved, very low ridge built up by channelled stream flow and left relict by channel migration. Part of a meander plain landform pattern.
SRP Scroll plain large flat resulting from aggradation by channelled stream flow as a stream migrates from side to side; the dominant element of a meander plain landform pattern. This landform element may include occurrences of scroll, swale and ox-bow.
DOL Solution steep-sided, circular or elliptical closed depression, doline commonly funnel-shaped, characterised by subsurface
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 42 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
43
drainage and formed by dissolution of the surface or underlying bedrock.
STB Stream bed linear, generally sinuous open depression forming the bottom of a stream channel, eroded and locally excavated, aggraded or built up by channelled stream flow. Parts that are built up include bars.
STC Stream linear, generally sinuous open depression, in parts channel eroded, excavated, built up and aggraded by channelled
stream flow. This element comprises stream bed and banks.
SUS Summit very wide, level to gently inclined crest with abrupt surface margins, commonly eroded by water-aided mass
movement or sheet wash.
STF Supratidal see Tidal flat. flat
SWL Swale (i) linear, level-floored open depression excavated by wind, or left relict between ridges built up by wind or waves, or built up to a lesser height than them. (ii) long, curved open or closed depression left relict between scrolls built up by channelled stream flow.
SWP Swamp almost level, closed or almost closed depression with a seasonal or permanent watertable at or above the surface, commonly aggraded by overbank stream flow and sometimes biological (peat) accumulation.
TAL Talus moderately inclined or steep waning lower slope, consisting of rock fragments aggraded by gravity.
TEF Terrace flat small flat aggraded or eroded by channelled or overbank stream flow, standing above a scarp and no longer frequently inundated; a former valley flat or part of a former flood plain.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 43 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
44
TEP Terrace large or very large flat aggraded by channelled or plain overbank stream flow, standing above a scarp and no
longer frequently inundated; part of a former flood plain.
TDC Tidal creek intermittently water-filled open depression in parts eroded, excavated, built up and aggraded by channelled tide-water flow; type of stream channel characterised by a rapid increase in width downstream.
TDF Tidal flat large flat subject to inundation by water that is usually salt or brackish, aggraded by tides. An intertidal flat (ITF) is frequently inundated; a supratidal flat (STF) is seldom inundated.
TOR Tor steep to precipitous hillock, typically convex, with a surface mainly of bare rock, either coherent or comprising subangular to rounded, large boulders (exhumed core-stones, also themselves called tors) separated by open fissures; eroded by sheet wash or water-aided mass movement.
TRE Trench open depression excavated by human activity.
TUM Tumulus hillock heaved up by volcanism (or, elsewhere, built up by human activity at a burial site).
VLF Valley flat small, gently inclined to level flat, aggraded or sometimes eroded by channelled or overbank stream flow, typically enclosed by hillslopes; a miniature alluvial plain landform pattern.
DESCRIPTION OF LANDFORM PATTERNThe significant kinds of landform pattern in Australia may be described and differentiated by the following attributes assessed within a circle of about 300 m radius:
reliefmodal slopestream channel occurrencemode of geomorphological activity
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 44 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
45
geomorphological agentstatus of geomorphological activitycomponent landform elements.
The glossary that follows (‘Landform pattern glossary’, page 55) is based explicitly on these attributes. Many other attributes may be observed, particularly by means of air photos (Speight 1977), thereby permitting finer discrimination between landform patterns. Landform pattern description is seldom built up from field observations alone, so that this section is marginal to the purpose of the Handbook. It aims rather to provide a secure broader geomorphological context for field work.
In the field, the observer should take care not to include parts of adjacent dissimilar landform patterns and thereby compromise the description of the landform pattern in which the observation point is found. Landform pattern boundaries, such as hillslope–flood plain junctions or dissection heads, may be recorded by a diagram.
ReliefRelief is defined as the difference in elevation between the high and low points of a land surface. Its estimation is made easier by visualising two surfaces of accordance that are planar or gently curved, one touching the major crests of a landform pattern, and the other passing through the major depressions. The average vertical separation of the two surfaces is a measure of the relief. Make this estimation at a field site, either visually or by using a map, and express it in metres.
Relief is the definitive characteristic for the terms mountains, hills, low hills, rises and plains when used as types of erosional landform pattern (Table 5). The class boundaries, shown in Tables 5 and 6, are set at 300 m, 90 m, 30 m and 9 m. These class limits and the class names are similar to those used by Löffler (1974), and are broadly compatible with those of Löffler and Ruxton (1969).
Table 6 lists types of landform pattern defined in the ‘Landform pattern glossary’ according to their typical relief class. Those types for which the relief class is definitive are in italics.
Modal slopeModal slope is defined as the most common class of slope occurring in a landform pattern. Where slope classes have been obtained by systematic sampling, define the classes using equal increments on a scale of the logarithm
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 45 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
46
of the slope tangent, a procedure intended to normalise frequency distributions of observed slope (Speight 1971). Where the most common slope class is estimated by direct observation, the estimate can be compared with the calculated value by using the log–normal model.
Modal slope class determines the use of certain adjectives applied to landform patterns that are characterised by alternating crests and depressions. These are: rolling for moderate modal slopes (10–32%); undulating for gentle slopes (3–10%); and gently undulating for very gentle slopes (1–3%) (cf. Soil Survey Staff 1951, pages 161–5). The other slope classes, precipitous, very steep, steep and level, are to be applied as they stand. The terminology for simple erosional landform patterns based on relief and modal slope is given in Table 5.
Table 5 defines the category badlands by various combinations of high slope values and low relief values. These combinations imply extremely close spacing of streams or valleys. Specifically, if one assumes a sawtooth terrain profile, the valley spacing implied is less than 100 m in areas with 50 m relief and less than 30 m in areas with 5 m relief; these values appear to accord with usage.
Table 7 lists types of landform pattern in order of their typical class of modal slope. This table should not be regarded as definitive, because slope within each type of landform pattern may vary widely.
Short description of a landform patternThe categories of relief and modal slope class given by the code letters in the margins of Table 5, added to a name from the ‘Landform pattern glossary’, form the briefest description of landform patterns that is likely to be useful. Named landform pattern types are discriminated by many other attributes, some of which are given below. Type names must be used with great care. In the ‘Landform pattern glossary’, cross-references are given to the similar landform pattern types with which a given type could be confused.
Stream channel occurrenceSeveral attributes that describe the occurrence and pattern of surface stream channels have diagnostic value. Use of the following attributes may clarify the observable differences between landform patterns, particularly in plains where mapping criteria are elusive.
When assessing attributes of stream channel occurrence, it is easy to make errors by not setting limits to the area to be described. Tentative landform pattern boundaries must be drawn to clarify these limits. Major stream
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 46 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Landform
47
Tabl
e 5
Sim
ple
type
s of
ero
sion
al la
ndfo
rm p
atte
rn c
hara
cter
ised
by
relie
f and
mod
al s
lope
Mod
al t
erra
in s
lope
LE
VG
GE
MO
ST
VS
PR
Rel
ief
Leve
l <
1%
(~ 1
:300
)
Ver
y ge
ntly
in
clin
ed
1–3%
(~
2%
)
Gen
tly
incl
ined
3
–10%
(~
6%
)
Mod
erat
ely
incl
ined
10
–32%
(~
20%
)
Stee
p 32
–56%
(~
40%
)
Ver
y st
eep
56–1
00%
(~
70%
)
Prec
ipit
ous
>100
%
(~ 1
50%
)
MV
ery
high
>
300
m
(~ 5
00 m
)
——
—R
MR
ollin
g m
ount
ains
SM
Stee
p m
ount
ains
VM
Ver
y st
eep
mou
ntai
ns
PM
Prec
ipito
us
mou
ntai
ns
HH
igh
90–3
00 m
(~
150
m)
——
UH
Und
ulat
ing
hills
RH
Rol
ling
hills
SH
Stee
p hi
llsV
HV
ery
stee
p hi
lls
PH
Prec
ipito
us
hills
LLo
w
30–9
0 m
(~
50
m)
——
UL
Und
ulat
ing
low
hill
s
RL
Rol
ling
low
hill
sS
LSt
eep
low
hi
lls
VL
Ver
y st
eep
low
hill
s
B Bad
land
s
RV
ery
low
9
–30
m
(~ 1
5 m
)
—G
RG
ently
un
dula
ting
rise
s
UR
Und
ulat
ing
rise
s
RR
Rol
ling
rise
sS
RSt
eep
rise
sB B
adla
nds
B Bad
land
s
PEx
trem
ely
low
<
9 m
(~
5 m
)
LP
Leve
l pl
ain
GP
Gen
tly
undu
latin
g pl
ain
UP
Und
ulat
ing
plai
n
RP
Rol
ling
plai
nB B
adla
nds
B Bad
land
sB B
adla
nds
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 47 4/02/09 12:05:22 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
48
channels are best mapped as wholly within one landform pattern or another, rather than marking a boundary.
Stream channel spacingThe average spacing of stream channels, L/N, is determined by counting the number, N, of their intersections with an arbitrary line of length L.6
A convenient tool for estimating channel spacing is a circle, with a circumference of 2 km at map or photo scale, drawn on transparent material.
Suitable classes for stream channel spacing, based on existing data, are:
AB Absent or very rare >2500 mSP Sparse 1585–2500 mVW Very widely spaced 1000–1585 mWS Widely spaced 625–1000 mMS Moderately spaced 400–625 mCS Closely spaced 250–400 mVC Very closely spaced 158–250 mNU Numerous <158 m
6 The average spacing, L/N, is the reciprocal of stream channel frequency, N/L (Speight 1977), a measure advocated by McCoy (1971) to replace the less convenient drainage density, Dd (Horton 1945). Mark (1974) has demonstrated a logical and empirical relationship from which it follows that stream channel spacing is related to drainage density by:
L/N = 1.571/Dd
Table 6 Landform pattern types ordered by typical relief class (those types for which the relief class is definitive are in italics)
Typical relief Landform pattern types
Very high >300 m Mountains, volcano
High 90–300 m Hills, volcano, caldera, meteor crater
Low 30–90 m Low hills, volcano, caldera, meteor crater
Very low 9–30 m Rises, terrace, dunefield, lava plain, coral reef, peneplain, karst
Extremely low <9 m Plain, pediment, pediplain, sheet-flood fan, alluvial fan, alluvial plain, flood plain, meander plain, bar plain, covered plain, anastomotic plain, stagnant alluvial plain, delta, playa plain, tidal flat, beach ridge plain, chenier plain, sand plain, made land
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 48 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
49
Stream channel developmentThe degree of development of stream channels may be categorised as follows:
O Absent no traces of channelled flow can be detected.I Incipient traces of channelled flow are very shallow, narrow
and discontinuous.E Erosional continuous linear channels occur; their width and
depth are considerable and display somewhat constant values suited to the available flow. Flood plains are not formed.
A Alluvial continuous linear channels occur, with rather large width and depth; they are essentially constant with downstream distance and are suited to the available flow. Flood plains of vertical or lateral accretion are formed.
Channel depth relative to widthChannel depth and width refer to the dimensions of a landform that is dominated by channelled stream flow. The limit of channelled stream flow dominance must be identified before width or depth can be estimated. Depth is taken from the top of the stream bank down to the average height of the line following the deepest part of the channel.
Table 7 Landform pattern types ordered by typical modal slope class
Typical modal slope class Landform pattern types
Precipitous >100% (Rare in Australia)
Very steep 56–100% Mountains, escarpment, volcano, caldera
Steep 32–56% Hills
Moderately inclined 10–32% Low hills, karst, meteor crater
Gently inclined 3–10% Rises, beach ridge plain, dunefield, lava plain, coral reef
Very gently inclined 1–3% Pediments, alluvial fan, sand plain
Level <1% Plains, sheet-flood fan, pediplain, peneplain, alluvial plain, flood plain, meander plain, bar plain, covered plain, anastomotic plain, stagnant alluvial plain, terrace, tidal flat, made land, playa plain
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 49 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
50
The distinction between stream bank and hillslope or scarp according to dominant process requires particular care where streams are incised, especially if they are cut into terraces that could be mistaken for flood plains.
For detailed studies, keep records of width and depth measurements. In other surveys, use the following classes of relative depth.
D Deep width/depth ratio <20:1M Moderately
deepwidth/depth ratio 20:1 to 50:1
S Shallow width/depth ratio 50:1 to 150:1V Very shallow width/depth ratio >150:1
Stream channel migrationThe presence of relict channel landforms or unvegetated, newly formed or immovable channel margins may permit an assessment of channel migration as:
R Rapidly migratingS Slowly migratingF Fixed
Stream-wise channel patternIn a traverse downstream, it may happen that tributaries enter the stream at frequent intervals, or that the stream splits into distributaries, or that these tendencies are absent (the non-tributary case) or are in balance with each other (the braided or anastomotic case, called here reticulated) giving four classes of stream-wise channel pattern (Figure 4a):
T TributaryN Non-tributaryD DistributaryR Reticulated
Channel network integrationIn an integrated channel network, one can traverse from any point on a stream channel to any other point on a stream channel without passing through any
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 50 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
51
(a) Stream-wise channel patterns
(b) Integration of channel network
(c) Channel network directionality
TRIBUTARY NON-TRIBUTARY
RETICULATED
DISTRIBUTARY
INTEGRATED INTERRUPTED DISINTEGRATED
CENTRIFUGAL DIVERGENT UNIDIRECTIONAL
CONVERGENTCENTRIPETAL NON-DIRECTIONAL
Figure 4 Stream channel pattern attributes.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 51 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
52
landform elements other than stream channels. The channel network may be interrupted at points where water loss into the ground or the atmosphere is sufficiently large, and in the extreme case, typical of karst terrain, the surface stream network is disintegrated. Classes of channel network integration (Figure 4b) are:
I IntegratedP Interrupted (partial integration)D Disintegrated
Channel network directionalityThis attribute combines two simpler attributes: the degree of lineation, that is, the degree to which the channels tend to align in an organised way; and the degree of convergence or divergence of channels downstream (Figure 4c). The latter is distinct from tributary/distributary behaviour, which refers to the combining and splitting of stream channels, rather than their directionality. Proposed classes are:
F Centrifugal maximum divergence >90ºD Divergent maximum divergence between 10º and 90ºU Unidirectional convergence or divergence <10ºC Convergent maximum convergence between 10º and 90ºP Centripetal maximum convergence >90ºB Bidirectional two lineations (e.g. ‘trellis’)N Non-directional no significant orientation, convergence or divergence
To illustrate the significance of stream channel occurrence in discriminating between landform patterns, Table 8 presents examples of landform pattern types ordered according to each of these seven attributes.
Mode of geomorphological activityThe modes of geomorphological activity are those considered in the description of landform elements (see Figure 3, page 30). Table 9 indicates the dominant mode of geomorphological activity in common types of landform pattern.
Geomorphological agentLandform patterns are subject to the same geomorphological agents as are landform elements (see Table 3, page 31). The problems of assigning agents
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 52 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
53
Table 8 Examples of types of landform pattern ordered according to attributes of stream channel occurrence
Attributes of stream channel occurrence Examples of landform pattern types
Stream channel spacing
Absent or very rare Sparse Very widely spaced Widely spaced Moderately spaced Closely spaced Very closely spaced Numerous
Sand plain, beach ridge plain Made land Very steep mountains Meander plain, steep hills Anastomotic plain, undulating rises Steep low hills Precipitous hills Badlands, bar plain, pediment
Stream channel development
Absent Incipient Erosional Alluvial
Dunefield, pediplain, playa plain Pediment, sheet-flood fan Mountains, hills, rises Meander plain, bar plain, covered plain
Stream channel depth relative to width
Deep Moderately deep Shallow Very shallow
Covered plain, anastomotic plain Meander plain Bar plain Pediment
Stream channel migration
Rapidly migrating Slowly migrating Fixed
Bar plain, meander plain Covered plain Mountains, hills, rises
Stream-wise channel pattern
Tributary Non-tributary Distributary Reticulated
Mountains, hills, rises Meander plain, covered plain Delta, sheet-flood fan, pediment Bar plain, anastomotic plain
Stream channel network integration
Integrated Interrupted (partial integration) Disintegrated
Mountains, hills, rises Volcano Karst
Stream channel network directionality
Centrifugal Divergent Unidirectional Convergent Centripetal Non-directional
Volcano Pediment, sheet-flood fan Meander plain, bar plain, covered plain Hills, rises Caldera Mountains, hills, rises
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 53 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
54
and of expressing the relative significance of more than one agent for a landform pattern are even more acute than for landform elements. Make provision for listing dominant, co-dominant and accessory geomorphological agents. Table 10 shows the incidence of geomorphological agents in types of landform pattern.
Landform patterns, being larger than landform elements, commonly have longer histories. The landform pattern description often identifies longer acting or relict geomorphological modes and agents.
Status of geomorphological activityIt is important for theoretical and practical purposes to distinguish, if possible, between landform patterns in which the formative geomorphological processes continue at the present time, and those in which they are no longer active, the landform features being relict. The problem in assigning activity status is that many processes are episodic, so that the observation of no activity may mean that an episodic process is in a quiescent phase. The following scale does not distinguish between processes that operate continuously but extremely slowly and those episodic processes that are very rare:
Table 9 Landform pattern types grouped according to the dominant mode of geomorphological activity
Dominant mode of geomorphological activity Landform pattern types
Gradational
ER Eroded Mountains, hills, rises, karst, pediplain, peneplain
EA Eroded or aggraded Pediment, made land
AG Aggraded Alluvial plain, flood plain, alluvial fan, bar plain, meander plain, covered plain, terrace, sheet-flood fan, lava plain, playa plain, tidal flat
Anti-gradational
HU Heaved up Marine plain
BU Built up Volcano, coral reef, dunefield, beach ridge plain
EX Excavated Caldera, meteor crater
SU Subsided (Rare in Australia)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 54 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
55
C Continuously activeF Frequently activeS Seldom activeB Barely active to inactiveR RelictU Unspecified
Table 11 shows how types of landform pattern vary in their status of geomorphological activity. Note that flood plains, including bar plains, meander plains, covered plains, anastomotic plains, and deltas, are distinguished from terraces or stagnant alluvial plains by having frequently active rather than seldom active or inactive stream flow. This may have legal significance. The frequency of occurrence of inundation (see page 138) that is classed as frequently active in this Handbook is an Average Recurrence Interval of 50 years or less.
A landform pattern may change from one type to another type if the status of geomorphological activity changes for any reason, including human interference (e.g. diverting a stream or building a dam).
Component landform elementsCertain kinds of landform element are typical of a given landform pattern. Some are found commonly and others occasionally in a given type. These landform elements are listed for each type of landform pattern in the ‘Landform pattern glossary’.
LANDFORM PATTERN GLOSSARYThe definitions in this glossary refer explicitly to the attributes of landform patterns that have been set down in the preceding sections. Consequently, they differ from the original definitions by the cited authors.
Cross-references and the tables in this section should be used to distinguish between landform pattern types that are similar. Alluvial fan, sheet-flood fan and pediment are particularly difficult to distinguish. They differ mainly in that stream channels are better developed and deeper on
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 55 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
56
Tabl
e 10
Inc
iden
ce o
f geo
mor
phol
ogic
al a
gent
s in
type
s of
land
form
pat
tern
Land
form
pat
tern
s
Geo
mor
phol
ogic
al a
gent
Dom
inan
t ag
ent
Co-
dom
inan
t ag
ent
Acc
esso
ry a
gent
GR
Gra
vity
: col
laps
e, o
r pa
rtic
le
fall
(Rar
e in
Aus
tral
ia)
Hill
s et
c., k
arst
, vol
cano
, du
nefie
ld, m
eteo
r cr
ater
Prec
ipit
atio
n
SO
Solu
tion
Kar
st
SM
Soil
moi
stur
e st
atus
cha
nges
; cr
eep
Hill
s et
c.Pl
aya
plai
n
WM
Wat
er-a
ided
mas
s m
ovem
ents
; lan
dslid
esH
ills
etc.
SH
Shee
t flo
w, s
heet
was
h,
surf
ace
was
hH
ills
etc.
, she
et-f
lood
fan,
pe
dim
ent,
pedi
plai
n,
pene
plai
n
Play
a pl
ain
Kar
st
Stre
am f
low
OV
Ove
rban
k st
ream
flow
, un
chan
nelle
dC
over
ed p
lain
, ana
stom
otic
pl
ain
Floo
d pl
ain,
allu
vial
pla
in,
terr
ace
CH
Cha
nnel
led
stre
am fl
owM
eand
er p
lain
, bar
pla
inFl
ood
plai
n, a
lluvi
al p
lain
, te
rrac
e
WI
Win
dD
unef
ield
Play
a pl
ain,
bea
ch r
idge
pl
ain
Bea
ch r
idge
pla
in, p
edim
ent
Ice
FR
Fros
t, in
clud
ing
free
ze–t
haw
(Rar
e in
Aus
tral
ia)
Hill
s et
c.
GL
Gla
cier
flow
(Rar
e in
Aus
tral
ia)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 56 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
57
Land
form
pat
tern
s
Geo
mor
phol
ogic
al a
gent
Dom
inan
t ag
ent
Co-
dom
inan
t ag
ent
Acc
esso
ry a
gent
Stan
ding
wat
er
WA
Wav
esLa
cust
rine
plai
nB
each
rid
ge p
lain
, pla
ya
plai
nTi
dal f
lat
TI
Tide
sTi
dal f
lat
Bea
ch r
idge
pla
in
EU
Eust
asy:
cha
nges
in s
ea le
vel
(Rar
e in
Aus
tral
ia)
Inte
rnal
for
ces
DI
Dia
stro
phis
m: e
arth
m
ovem
ents
(Rar
e in
Aus
tral
ia)
VO
Vol
cani
smV
olca
no, c
alde
ra, l
ava
plai
n
Bio
logi
cal a
gent
s
BI
Non
-hum
an b
iolo
gica
l ag
ents
; cor
alC
oral
ree
f
HU
Hum
an a
gent
sM
ade
land
Extr
ater
rest
rial
age
nts
IMIm
pact
by
met
eors
Met
eor
crat
er
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 57 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
58
alluvial fans, and that pediments are almost entirely erosional while the fans are depositional.
Riverine landform patterns comprise a hierarchical classification (Table 12). The four types of flood plain differ in various ways, as set out in Table 13.
ALF Alluvial fan level (less than 1% slope) to very gently inclined, complex landform pattern of extremely low relief. The rapidly migrating alluvial stream channels are shallow to moderately deep, locally numerous, but elsewhere widely spaced. The channels form a centrifugal to divergent, integrated, reticulated to distributary pattern. The landform pattern includes areas that are bar plains, being aggraded or eroded by frequently active channelled stream flow, and other areas comprising terraces or stagnant alluvial plains with slopes that are greater than usual, formed by channelled stream flow but now relict. Incision in the upslope area may give rise to an erosional stream bed between scarps. Typical elements: stream bed, bar, plain. Common element: scarp. Compare with Sheet-flood fan and Pediment.
Table 11 Typical activity status of the dominant geomorphological agent in types of landform pattern
Typical activity status Landform patterns
Continuously active Mountains, hills, rises, karst, coral reef
Frequently active Pediment, sheet-flood fan, flood plain, bar plain, meander plain, covered plain, anastomotic plain, alluvial fan, tidal flat, dunefield, playa plain
Seldom active Volcano, (lower) terrace
Barely active to inactive Pediplain, peneplain, stagnant alluvial plain
Relict Caldera, meteor crater, (higher) terrace, beach ridge plain, lava plain, made land
Unspecified Plain, alluvial plain
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 58 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
59
ALP Alluvial plain level landform pattern with extremely low relief. The shallow to deep alluvial stream channels are sparse to widely spaced, forming a unidirectional, integrated network. There may be frequently active erosion and aggradation by channelled and overbank stream flow, or the landforms may be relict from these processes. Typical elements: stream channel (stream bed and bank), plain (dominant). Common elements: bar, scroll, levee, backplain, swamp. Occasional elements: ox-bow, flood-out, lake. Included types of landform pattern are: flood plain, bar plain, meander plain, covered plain, anastomotic plain, delta, stagnant alluvial plain, terrace, terraced land.
ANA Anastomotic flood plain with slowly migrating, deep alluvial plain channels, usually moderately spaced, forming a
divergent to unidirectional, integrated reticulated network. There is frequently active aggradation by overbank and channelled stream flow.
Table 12 Classification of riverine landform patterns
Low or very low relief
More than one plain level Terraced land (alluvial)
One plain level (seldom active or relict) Terrace (alluvial)
Extremely low relief
Undifferentiated Alluvial plain
Inactive or barely active Stagnant alluvial plain
Frequently active in sea or lake elsewhere undifferentiated differentiated
Delta
Flood plain Bar plain Meander plain Covered plain Anastomotic plain
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 59 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
60
Tabl
e 13
Dis
crim
inat
ion
betw
een
flood
pla
ins
Att
ribu
tes
Type
of f
lood
pla
in
Bar
pla
inM
eand
er p
lain
Cov
ered
pla
inA
nast
omot
ic p
lain
Stre
am c
hann
el
Spac
ing
Num
erou
sW
idel
y sp
aced
Wid
ely
spac
edM
oder
atel
y sp
aced
Dep
th/w
idth
Shal
low
Mod
erat
ely
deep
Dee
pD
eep
Mig
ratio
nR
apid
Rap
idSl
owSl
ow
Stre
am-w
ise
patte
rnR
etic
ulat
edN
on-t
ribu
tary
Non
-tri
buta
ryR
etic
ulat
ed
Net
wor
k di
rect
iona
lity
Uni
dire
ctio
nal
Uni
dire
ctio
nal
Uni
dire
ctio
nal
Div
erge
nt/
unid
irec
tiona
l
Mod
e ge
omor
phol
ogic
al a
ctiv
ity
Erod
ed/a
ggra
ded
Erod
ed/a
ggra
ded
Agg
rade
dA
ggra
ded
Geo
mor
phol
ogic
al a
gent
Dom
inan
tC
hann
elle
d st
ream
flow
Cha
nnel
led
stre
am fl
owO
verb
ank
stre
am fl
owO
verb
ank
stre
am fl
ow
Min
or—
Ove
rban
k st
ream
flow
—C
hann
elle
d st
ream
flow
Land
form
ele
men
ts
Scro
ll pl
ain
Dom
inan
t
Bac
kpla
inD
omin
ant
Dom
inan
t
Stre
am c
hann
elTy
pica
lTy
pica
lTy
pica
lTy
pica
l
st
ream
bed
Typi
cal
Typi
cal
Typi
cal
Typi
cal
ba
rD
omin
ant
Typi
cal
ba
nkTy
pica
l
Scro
llTy
pica
l
Leve
eTy
pica
lTy
pica
l
Swam
pC
omm
onC
omm
on
Ox-
bow
Com
mon
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 60 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
61
Typical elements: stream channel (stream bed and bank), levee, backplain (dominant). Common element: swamp. Compare with other types under Alluvial plain and Flood plain.
BAD Badlands landform pattern of low to extremely low relief (less than 90 m) and steep to precipitous slopes, typically with numerous fixed, erosional stream channels which form a non-directional, integrated tributary network. There is continuously active erosion by collapse, landslide, sheet flow, creep and channelled stream flow. Typical elements: ridge (dominant), stream bed or gully. Occasional elements: summit surface, hillcrest, hillslope, talus. Compare with Mountains, Hills, Low hills, Rises and Plain.
BAR Bar plain flood plain with numerous rapidly migrating, shallow alluvial channels forming a unidirectional, integrated reticulated network. There is frequently active aggradation and erosion by channelled stream flow. (Described by Melton 1936.) Typical elements: stream bed, bar (dominant). Compare with other types under Alluvial plain and Flood plain.
BEA Beach ridge level to gently undulating landform pattern of plain extremely low relief on which stream channels are
absent or very rare; it consists of relict, parallel beach ridges. Typical elements: beach ridge (co-dominant), swale (co-dominant). Common elements: beach, foredune, tidal creek. Compare with Chenier plain.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 61 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
62
CAL Caldera rare landform pattern typically of very high relief and steep to precipitous slope. It is without stream channels or has fixed, erosional channels forming a centripetal, integrated tributary pattern. The landform has subsided or was excavated as a result of volcanism. Typical elements: scarp, hillslope, lake. Occasional elements: cone, hillcrest, stream channel.
CHE Chenier plain level to gently undulating landform pattern of extremely low relief on which stream channels are very rare. The pattern consists of relict, parallel, linear ridges built up by waves, separated by, and built over, flats (mud flats) aggraded by tides or overbank stream flow. Typical elements: beach ridge (co-dominant), flat (co-dominant). Common elements: tidal flat, swamp, beach, foredune, tidal creek. Compare with Beach ridge plain.
COR Coral reef continuously active or relict landform pattern built up to the sea level of the present day or of a former time by corals and other organisms. It is mainly level, with moderately inclined to precipitous slopes below the sea level. Stream channels are generally absent, but there may occasionally be fixed, deep, erosional tidal stream channels forming a disintegrated non-tributary pattern. Typical elements: reef flat, lagoon, cliff (submarine). Common elements: beach, beach ridge.
COV Covered plain flood plain with slowly migrating, deep alluvial channels, usually widely spaced and forming a unidirectional, integrated non-tributary network. There is frequently active aggradation by overbank stream flow. (Described by Melton 1936.)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 62 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
63
Typical elements: stream channel (stream bed and bank), levee, backplain (dominant). Common element: swamp. Compare with other types under Alluvial plain and Flood plain.
DEL Delta flood plain projecting into a sea or lake, with slowly migrating, deep alluvial channels, usually moderately spaced, typically forming a divergent, integrated distributary network. This landform is aggraded by frequently active overbank and channelled stream flow that is modified by tides. Typical elements: stream channel (stream bed and bank), levee, backplain (co-dominant), swamp (co-dominant), lagoon (co-dominant). Common elements: beach ridge, swale, beach, estuary, tidal creek. Compare with other types under Alluvial plain, Flood plain and Chenier plain.
DUN Dunefield level to rolling landform pattern of very low or extremely low relief without stream channels, built up or locally excavated, eroded or aggraded by wind. Typical elements: dune or dunecrest, duneslope, swale, blow-out, risecrest, residual rise, riseslope. Common elements: hummocky dune, barchan dune, parabolic dune, linear dune. Included types of landform pattern are: longitudinal dunefield, parabolic dunefield.
ESC Escarpment steep to precipitous landform pattern forming a linearly extensive, straight or sinuous, inclined surface, which separates terrains at different altitudes; a plateau is commonly above the escarpment. Relief within the landform pattern may be high (hilly) or low (planar). The upper margin is often marked by an included cliff or scarp.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 63 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
64
Typical elements: hillcrest, hillslope, cliff-footslope. Common elements: cliff, scarp, scarp-footslope, talus, footslope, alcove. Occasional element: stream bed.
FLO Flood plain alluvial plain characterised by frequently active erosion and aggradation by channelled or overbank stream flow. Unless otherwise specified, ‘frequently active’ is to mean that flow has an Average Recurrence Interval of 50 years or less. Typical elements: stream channel (stream bed and bank), plain (dominant). Common elements: bar, scroll, levee, backplain, swamp. Occasional elements: ox-bow, flood-out, scroll. Included types of landform pattern are: bar plain, meander plain, covered plain, anastomotic plain. Related relict landform patterns are: stagnant alluvial plain, terrace, terraced land (partly relict).
HIL Hills landform pattern of high relief (90–300 m) with gently inclined to precipitous slopes. Fixed, shallow, erosional stream channels, closely to very widely spaced, form a non-directional or convergent, integrated tributary network. There is continuously active erosion by wash and creep and, in some cases, rarely active erosion by landslides. Typical elements: hillcrest, hillslope (dominant), drainage depression, stream bed. Common elements: footslope, alcove, valley flat, gully. Occasional elements: tor, summit surface, scarp, landslide, talus, bench, terrace, doline. Compare with Mountains, Low hills, Rises and Plain.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 64 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
65
KAR Karst landform pattern of unspecified relief and slope (for specification use the terms in Table 5, e.g. ‘Karst rolling hills’) typically with fixed, deep, erosional stream channels forming a non-directional, disintegrated tributary pattern and many closed depressions without stream channels. It is eroded by continuously active solution and rarely active collapse, the products being removed through underground channels. Typical elements: hillcrest, hillslope (dominant), doline. Common elements: summit surface, valley flat, plain, alcove, drainage depression, stream channel, scarp, footslope, landslide. Occasional element: talus.
LAC Lacustrine level landform pattern with extremely low relief plain formerly occupied by a lake but now partly or
completely dry. It is relict after aggradation by waves and by deposition of material from suspension and solution in standing water. The pattern is usually bounded by wave-formed features such as cliffs, rock platforms, beaches, berms and lunettes. These may be included or excluded. Typical element: plain. Common elements: beach, cliff. Occasional elements: rock platform, berm. Compare with Playa plain.
LAV Lava plain level to undulating landform pattern of very low to extremely low relief typically with widely spaced, fixed, erosional stream channels that form a non-directional, integrated or interrupted tributary pattern. The landform pattern is aggraded by volcanism (lava flow) that is
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 65 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
66
generally relict; it is subject to erosion by continuously active sheet flow, creep, and channelled stream flow. Typical elements: plain, hillslope, stream bed. Occasional element: tumulus.
LON Longitudinal dunefield characterised by long, narrow sand dunefield dunes and wide, flat swales. The dunes are
oriented parallel with the direction of the prevailing wind, and in cross-section one slope is typically steeper than the other. Typical elements: dune or dunecrest, duneslope, swale, blow-out. Compare with Parabolic dunefield.
LOW Low hills landform pattern of low relief (30–90 m) and gentle to very steep slopes, typically with fixed, erosional stream channels, closely to very widely spaced, which form a non-directional or convergent, integrated tributary pattern. There is continuously active sheet flow, creep, and channelled stream flow. Typical elements: hillcrest, hillslope (dominant), drainage depression, stream bed. Common elements: footslope, alcove, valley flat, gully. Occasional elements: tor, summit surface, landslide, doline. Compare with Mountains, Hills, Rises and Plain.
MAD Made land landform pattern typically of very low or extremely low relief and with slopes either level or very steep. Sparse, fixed, deep, artificial stream channels form a non-directional, interrupted tributary pattern. The landform pattern is eroded and aggraded, and locally built up or excavated, by rarely active human agency. Typical elements: fill-top (dominant), cut-over
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 66 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
67
surface, cut face, embankment, berm, trench. Common elements: mound, pit, dam.
MAR Marine plain plain eroded or aggraded by waves, tides, or submarine currents, and aggraded by deposition of material from suspension and solution in sea water, elevated above sea level by earth movements or eustasy, and little modified by subaerial agents such as stream flow or wind. Typical element: plain. Occasional elements: dune, stream channel.
MEA Meander plain flood plain with widely spaced, rapidly migrating, moderately deep alluvial stream channels which form a unidirectional, integrated non-tributary network. There is frequently active aggradation and erosion by channelled stream flow with subordinate aggradation by overbank stream flow. (Described by Melton 1936.) Typical elements: stream channel (stream bed, bank and bar), scroll, scroll plain (dominant). Common element: ox-bow. Compare with other types under Alluvial plain and Flood plain.
MET Meteor crater rare landform pattern comprising a circular closed depression (see crater landform element) with a raised margin; it is typically of low to high relief and has a large range of slope values, without stream channels, or with a peripheral integrated pattern of centrifugal tributary streams. The pattern is excavated, heaved up and built up by a meteor impact and is now relict. Typical elements: crater (scarp, talus, footslope and plain), hillcrest, hillslope.
MOU Mountains landform pattern of very high relief (greater than 300 m) with moderate to precipitous slopes and
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 67 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
68
fixed, erosional stream channels that are closely to very widely spaced and form a non-directional or diverging, integrated tributary network. There is continuously active erosion by collapse, landslide, sheet flow, creep, and channelled stream flow. Typical elements: hillcrest, hillslope (dominant), stream bed. Common elements: talus, landslide, alcove, valley flat, scarp. Occasional elements: cirque, footslope. Compare with Hills, Low hills, Rises and Plain.
PAR Parabolic dunefield characterised by sand dunes with a dunefield long, scoop-shaped form, convex in the
downwind direction so that its trailing arms point upwind; the ground plan, when developed, approximates the form of a parabola. Where many parabolic dunes have been active, the trailing arms give the impression of a longitudinal dunefield. Typical elements: dune or dunecrest, duneslope, swale, blow-out. Compare with Longitudinal dunefield.
PED Pediment gently inclined to level (less than 1%) landform pattern of extremely low relief, typically with numerous rapidly migrating, very shallow incipient stream channels, which form a centrifugal to diverging, integrated reticulated pattern. It is underlain by bedrock, eroded, and locally aggraded, by frequently active channelled stream flow or sheet flow, with subordinate wind erosion. Pediments characteristically lie downslope from adjacent hills with markedly steeper slopes. Typical elements: pediment, plain, stream bed. Compare with Sheet-flood fan and Alluvial fan.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 68 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
69
PEP Pediplain level to very gently inclined landform pattern with extremely low relief and no stream channels, eroded by barely active sheet flow and wind. Largely relict from more effective erosion by stream flow in incipient stream channels as on a pediment. (Described by King 1953.) Typical element: plain.
PNP Peneplain level to gently undulating landform pattern with extremely low relief and sparse, slowly migrating alluvial stream channels which form a non-directional, integrated tributary pattern. It is eroded by barely active sheet flow, creep, and channelled and overbank stream flow. (Described by Davis 1889.) Typical elements: plain (dominant), stream channel.
PLA Plain level to undulating or, rarely, rolling landform pattern of extremely low relief (less than 9 m). Compare with Mountains, Hills, Low hills and Rises.
PLT Plateau level to rolling landform pattern of plains, rises or low hills standing above a cliff, scarp or escarpment that extends around a large part of its perimeter. A bounding scarp or cliff landform element may be included or excluded; a bounding escarpment would be an adjacent landform pattern. Typical elements: plain, summit surface, cliff. Common elements: hillcrest, hillslope, drainage depression, rock flat, scarp. Occasional element: stream channel.
PLY Playa plain level landform pattern with extremely low relief, typically without stream channels, aggraded by rarely active sheet flow and modified by wind, waves, and soil phenomena.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 69 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
70
Typical elements: playa, lunette, plain. Compare with Lacustrine plain.
RIS Rises landform pattern of very low relief (9–30 m) and very gentle to steep slopes. The fixed, erosional stream channels are closely to very widely spaced and form a non-directional to convergent, integrated or interrupted tributary pattern. The pattern is eroded by continuously active to barely active creep and sheet flow. Typical elements: hillcrest, hillslope (dominant), footslope, drainage depression, riseslope. Common elements: valley flat, stream channel. Occasional elements: gully, fan, tor. Compare with Mountains, Hills, Low hills and Plain.
SAN Sand plain level to gently undulating landform pattern of extremely low relief and without channels; formed possibly by sheet flow or stream flow, but now relict and modified by wind action. Typical element: plain. Occasional elements: dune, playa, lunette.
SHF Sheet-flood level (less than 1% slope) to very gently inclined fan landform pattern of extremely low relief with
numerous rapidly migrating, very shallow incipient stream channels forming a divergent to unidirectional, integrated or interrupted reticulated pattern. The pattern is aggraded by frequently active sheet flow and channelled stream flow, with subordinate wind erosion. Typical elements: plain, stream bed. Compare with Alluvial fan and Pediment.
STA Stagnant alluvial plain on which erosion and aggradation alluvial plain by channelled and overbank stream flow is barely
active or inactive because of reduced water supply,
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 70 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Landform
71
without apparent incision or channel enlargement that would lower the level of stream action. Typical elements: stream channel (stream bed and bank), plain (dominant). Common elements: bar, scroll, levee, backplain, swamp. Occasional elements: ox-bow, flood-out, lake. Compare with Flood plain and Terrace.
TER Terrace former flood plain on which erosion and (alluvial) aggradation by channelled and overbank stream
flow is barely active or inactive because deepening or enlargement of the stream channel has lowered the level of flooding. A pattern that has both a former flood plain and a significant, active flood plain, or that has former flood plains at more than one level, becomes terraced land. Typical elements: terrace plain (dominant), scarp, channel bench. Occasional elements: stream channel, scroll, levee.
TEL Terraced land landform pattern including one or more terraces (alluvial) and often a flood plain. Relief is low or very low
(9–90 m). Terrace plains or terrace flats occur at stated heights above the top of the stream bank. Typical elements: terrace plains, terrace flats, scarps, scroll plain, stream channel. Occasional elements: stream channel, scroll, levee.
TID Tidal flat level landform pattern with extremely low relief and slowly migrating, deep alluvial stream channels, which form non-directional, integrated tributary patterns; it is aggraded by frequently active tides. Typical elements: plain (dominant), intertidal flat, supratidal flat, stream channel. Occasional elements: lagoon, dune, beach ridge, beach.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 71 4/02/09 12:05:23 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
72
VOL Volcano typically very high and very steep landform pattern without stream channels, or with erosional stream channels forming a centrifugal, interrupted tributary pattern. The landform is built up by volcanism, and is modified by erosional agents. Typical elements: cone, crater. Common elements: scarp, hillcrest, hillslope, stream bed, lake, maar. Occasional element: tumulus.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 72 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
73
VEGETATIONR.J. Hnatiuk, R. Thackway and J. Walker
This chapter identifies which vegetation attributes should be measured and recorded at field sites in order to describe and classify Australian vegetation.7 The attributes chosen – as well as the required level of detail – depend on the purpose of the survey, which needs to be explicitly recorded.
Here we expand the previous version of this chapter (Walker and Hopkins 1990) to include wetlands, temperate rainforests, vegetation growth stage and vegetation condition. Other changes include new height classes, an increased number of broad floristic groups, and different codes for some attributes. We have also made several changes to the terms used to name vegetation units, based on their cover and broad floristic composition (see Table 21). The largest of these changes is the replacement of the terms ‘forest’ and ‘woodland’ with ‘trees’, and the deletion of the suffix ‘land’ from many of the units in the table. The translation from ‘trees’ to ‘woodland’, where it is relevant to certain users, is simple. These changes remove a number of anomalies and make the underlying importance of cover classes clear throughout the classification. Details of the rationale for these changes can be found in Hnatiuk et al. (2008). This chapter is available online (Hnatiuk et al. 2009) with hyperlinks to the additional information found in Hnatiuk et al. (2008).
The field data collected with these new methods are currently classified, coded and named differently than in the National Vegetation Information
7 The Executive Steering Committee for Australian Vegetation Information (ESCAVI) has endorsed this chapter as guidelines for the collection of site-based data on vegetation in Australia.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 73 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
74
System (NVIS) framework (ESCAVI 2003). Where there is a need to classify and map these field data according to the vegetation map units listed in the NVIS, we recommend users consult Thackway et al. (2008) and updates in Hnatiuk et al. (2008). Starting in 2008, NVIS will be changed progressively to match the classification in this chapter.
Before setting out into the field there are many aspects to consider. Guidance on timing, sample site location, sample detail and recording sheets for vegetation and ancillary information are outlined in Thackway et al. (2008) and Hnatiuk et al. (2008).
Here we briefly address the choice of sample site location. The historical approach is to locate sample sites within examples of native vegetation that are intact (i.e. not overly disturbed) and mature (i.e. not regeneration stages). Such sites are often called ‘potential vegetation’ (e.g. Carnahan 1977) representing the vegetation that sites with similar environments and disturbance regimes are expected to support at maturity. There is, however, increasing interest in successional (seral) stages of vegetation, from disturbance through recovery, maturing to senescence and subsequent disturbance. In some cases the dominant and other species will be replaced progressively by new species. Regular resampling can help elucidate these changes.
Vegetation samples collected in conjunction with fauna studies or restoration activities may also span different stages in the vegetation succession or recovery. These stages are likely to provide different fauna habitats and may also need to be recorded. Vegetation data are also used in habitat models, impacts of climate change, soil–water balances, disturbance impacts, restoration of disturbed sites, carbon sequestration and potential fuel loads. This chapter describes how to obtain the recommended core data for a standard classification as well as additional data about growth stage and condition required for these uses.
Most vegetation studies in Australia and elsewhere have concentrated on native plants in their natural habitats. The methods presented here are particularly suited to such studies and are also suitable for agricultural and horticultural vegetation (e.g. Abed and Stephens 2003; McNaught et al. 2006; Thackway and Lesslie 2006; BRS 2007). The vegetation structure of a wheat field, a cotton crop, a vineyard or a grazing paddock can all be sampled and reported with the methods presented here. Using a single comprehensive system to record all vegetation enables all vegetation of a landscape, region or continent to be integrated into a single system, which can then be used for holistic planning, assessment or modelling.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 74 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Vegetation
75
OVERVIEW OF THE CLASSIFICATIONVegetation is classified on the basis of structure (the vertical and horizontal distribution of vegetation: its growth form, height, cover and strata) and floristics (the dominant genera or species in various strata and characteristic plant species).
We initially use three levels of detail: the broadest units, formations; next structural formations; and the more detailed, broad floristic formations, as shown in Table 14 with examples in Table 15. Further subdivision to include more strata or plant species is possible. The level to use will depend on the purpose of the survey and the resources available. As seen in Table 16, these levels are conceptually equivalent to levels in NVIS and add a broad level intended for use with imagery (formation, i.e. woody or non-woody plant) to the previously recommended system (Walker and Hopkins 1990).
The levels of classification used here are defined as follows:
Level 1 – Formations are classified based on cover and whether the dominant plants are woody or non-woody. Formation is usually assessed from imagery before the field survey.Level 2 – Structural formations are classified and named on the basis of height, cover and growth form (e.g. tree, shrub, grass; see ‘Growth forms’ (page 88) for complete list of growth forms).Level 3 – Broad floristic formations are defined by adding genus or species names to the structural formation name in the order of height, cover, species and growth form. The dominant species in the dominant stratum is used.Additional levels – Dominant species in other layers are added to give broad floristic subformations and the ‘associations’ of other classification systems (equivalent to NVIS Levels IV to VI).
The progression from the simplest to a more detailed vegetation classification is shown by the example of Eucalyptus populnea vegetation with height of 21 metres and crowns nearly touching. Using the appropriate tables, this vegetation can be classified at different levels with the addition of progressively more detailed descriptions (Table 15 and Figure 8, page 104).
It is desirable to classify vegetation not only by a name but also with a code. A coding system for vegetation is essential for data storage and retrieval, air-photo marking and mapping. The codes must be computer compatible and
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 75 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
76
Tabl
e 14
Attr
ibut
es r
equi
red
to d
efin
e Le
vels
1, 2
and
3
Rec
ogni
seA
ttri
bute
s re
quir
edLe
vel o
f det
ail
Dom
inan
t str
atum
(pag
e 79
)
Mid
-str
atum
(if p
rese
nt)
Gro
und
stra
tum
(if p
rese
nt)
Rec
ord
(for
at
leas
t the
do
min
ant a
nd
grou
nd
stra
tum
)
1. L
ife fo
rm (w
oody
or
non-
woo
dy p
lant
) (pa
ge 8
0)
Form
atio
n
(Lev
el 1
):
reco
rd 1
–2
Stru
ctur
al
form
atio
n
(Lev
el 2
):
reco
rd 1
–7
Bro
ad fl
oris
tic
form
atio
n
(Lev
el 3
):
reco
rd 1
–8
2. C
over
of t
he d
omin
ant s
trat
um (c
row
n se
para
tion
or
folia
ge c
over
, see
Tab
le 1
7, p
age
81)
3. C
row
n ty
pe (s
ee F
igur
e 6,
pag
e 85
)
4. G
row
th fo
rms
(pag
e 88
) in
each
str
atum
5. H
eigh
t (se
e Ta
ble
20, p
age
95) o
f eac
h st
ratu
m
6. F
olia
ge c
over
of t
he lo
wer
str
ata
(pag
e 94
)
7. E
mer
gent
s (if
any
) (pa
ge 9
4)
8. S
peci
es o
f onl
y th
e do
min
ant s
trat
um (p
ages
95–
7)
NB
: Def
inin
g Le
vels
4–6
req
uire
s th
e ad
ditio
n of
mor
e st
rata
and
dom
inan
t spe
cies
in e
ach
stra
tum
(see
Fig
ure
8, p
age
104)
.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 76 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Vegetation
77
applicable at different levels of detail. Codes for vegetation have been assigned for cover, height, growth form and species or genera and are described in the remainder of the chapter.
This standard classification can be applied to all vegetation: native (including rainforest) and non-native. This chapter describes how to classify vegetation according to this standard method. First we describe how to recognise strata, and then how to measure attributes required for classification in increasing detail (Levels 1, 2 and then 3).
Some vegetation types, however, may require further detail, as explained in the final part of this chapter. Wetlands, for example, require extra attributes to separate otherwise indistinct types. Rainforests can also be treated as special cases. Some rainforests may be adequately described by the standard classification. Others – such as wet tropical/subtropical or cool temperate Tasmanian rainforests – require additional attributes. The chapter concludes with guidelines to add even more detail by assessing growth stage and condition.
RECOGNISING STRATAA stratum is an easily seen layer of foliage and branches of a measurable height. Vegetation can have one or more strata. A single stratum may extend
Table 15 Examples of the classification levels
Level Name Notes
Level 1 – Formation ‘Mid-dense woody plants’ Table 17 (see page 81) and life form (woody or non-woody plant)
Level 2 – Structural formation
‘Emergents over very tall mid-dense trees’ Tables 20 and 21 (see pages 95 and 98)
Level 3 – Broad floristic formation
‘Emergent very tall Angophora over very tall mid-dense Eucalyptus trees’
Tables 20 and 21 and floristics
Level 4 – Broad floristic subformation
‘Emergent very tall Angophora trees over very tall mid-dense Eucalyptus trees with tall sparse Eucalyptus tree understorey over dwarf very sparse Eremophila shrubs with a tall sparse Bothriochloa tussock grass ground stratum’
Tables 20 and 21 and floristics
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 77 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
78
Tabl
e 16
Com
paris
on o
f veg
etat
ion
clas
sific
atio
n sy
stem
s
Key
att
ribu
tes
This
pub
licat
ion
(Lev
el /
nam
e)N
VIS
(ES
CA
VI
2003
)(L
evel
/ n
ame)
Wal
ker
and
Hop
kins
(19
90)
(Nam
e)
Life
form
and
cov
er1
/ For
mat
ion
I / C
lass
NA
Gro
wth
form
, cov
er a
nd h
eigh
t of
the
dom
inan
t str
atum
and
em
erge
nts
2 / S
truc
tura
l for
mat
ion
II / S
truc
tura
l for
mat
ion
Stru
ctur
al fo
rmat
ion
(see
pag
es
60–1
in W
alke
r an
d H
opki
ns
(199
0))
Gro
wth
form
, cov
er, h
eigh
t and
ch
arac
teri
stic
spe
cies
/gen
era
in
the
dom
inan
t str
atum
3 / B
road
flor
istic
form
atio
n III
/ B
road
flor
istic
form
atio
nFl
oris
tic a
ssoc
iatio
n –
the
stru
ctur
al fo
rmat
ion
plus
ch
arac
teri
stic
spe
cies
/gen
era
in
the
dom
inan
t str
atum
(see
pag
e 76
in W
alke
r an
d H
opki
ns
(199
0))
Abo
ve, p
lus
the
dom
inan
t gen
era
for
each
str
atum
(upp
er, m
id a
nd
grou
nd)
4 / B
road
flor
istic
su
bfor
mat
ion
IV /
Bro
ad fl
oris
tic
subf
orm
atio
nSt
ruct
ural
sub
form
atio
n (p
age
74 in
Wal
ker
and
Hop
kins
(1
990
)) –
abov
e, p
lus
addi
tiona
l sp
ecie
s
Abo
ve p
lus
the
thre
e do
min
ant o
r co
-dom
inan
t spe
cies
in e
ach
stra
tum
Spec
ies
can
be a
dded
for
subs
trat
a (s
ee F
igur
e 8,
pa
ge 1
04)
V /
Ass
ocia
tion
Abo
ve p
lus
the
five
dom
inan
t or
co-d
omin
ant s
peci
es in
eac
h st
ratu
m
Spec
ies
can
be a
dded
for
subs
trat
a (s
ee F
igur
e 8)
VI /
Sub
asso
ciat
ion
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 78 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Vegetation
79
from the top of the canopy to near ground level. Record the median height of the top of each stratum in metres (see Figure 8, page 104). If foliage profiles are required for the habitat studied, also record the depth of the crowns in each stratum. Strata are named as follows:
U Dominant or upper stratum
In most cases, the tallest stratum will be the dominant stratum. Emergents are an exception (see ‘Emergents’).
M Mid-stratum if present, is between the dominant stratum and the lowest or ground stratum. When present, there are no preconceived height limits for this stratum. Record actual heights and fit into classes later.
G Ground stratum
can also be the dominant stratum (e.g. in places where grass cover is closed and trees are very sparse). No mandatory height limit on the ground layer, but it is usually less than 2.0 m tall.
At times it will be useful to record subdivisions of the three main strata. These substrata occur when a major stratum is composed of two or more different elements. For example, the dominant stratum may consist of one species that makes up most of the canopy, but its lower limit is made up mostly of a different species, a co-dominant. In such cases, separate strata do not really exist, but recognising a substratum may make it possible to elucidate a significant aspect of the vegetation (e.g. development stage or species mixtures).
EmergentsThe tallest plants in some vegetation are so sparse that they no longer form the dominant or most significant layer. For example, a few tall Araucaria or Eucalyptus trees may rise above a closed rainforest canopy, or widely scattered eucalypts or acacias may rise above lower shrubs or grasses in semiarid regions. The tallest stratum is then classified as an ‘emergent layer’ (see ‘Emergents’, page 94, for definition and discussion) and the dominant layer on which the vegetation will be classified is usually the next tallest layer.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 79 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
80
Complex canopies due to regrowthVegetation that has been disturbed or is still recovering from certain kinds of disturbance can produce complex canopies. For example, where a canopy has been reduced – but not totally removed – by clearing, ringbarking or poisoning, two or more cohorts of canopy species may occur. When of clearly different ages, the cohorts are also likely to differ in height, making the description of the canopy difficult.
The methods already described for defining dominant stratum and emergents should be applied. This type of vegetation can be further characterised by recording ‘uneven age’ when assessing growth stage (see Table 28). The different cohorts should not be amalgamated unless they are too similar in structure to be distinguished consistently. Arbitrary height boundaries should not be used to separate them.
FORMATION (LEVEL 1)Life formLife form describes what a plant looks like. At the most general level of classification, formations, there are only two life forms: woody plants (w) and non-woody plants (nw). Woody plants include all trees, palms, arborescent cycads, tree ferns, xanthorrhoeas, shrubs and woody vines. All other plants with little or no woody tissue are classified as non-woody including annuals, grasses, grass-like plants, forbs, crusts, bryophytes and algae.
Cover and crown typeThe recorded cover values collected using the methods below can be converted to cover classes as shown in Table 17. Crown cover classes are those used in Walker and Hopkins (1990) and these were selected to coincide as closely as possible with the cover classes of previous classifications (e.g. the projective foliage cover classes of Specht et al. 1974).
The three commonly used field measures of cover are: crown cover, foliage cover and projective foliage cover. Each gives different values and none is correlated in a simple way with leaf area or leaf area index.
Crown cover (C) (Walker and Hopkins 1990) is the percentage of the sample site within the vertical projection of the periphery of the crowns with
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 80 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Vegetation
81
the crowns considered to be opaque. This is also the generic definition of canopy cover or plant cover.
Foliage cover (Carnahan 1977; Walker and Hopkins 1990) is the percentage of the sample site occupied by the vertical projection of foliage and woody branches.
Projective foliage cover (PFC) (Specht et al. 1974) is the percentage of the sample site occupied by the vertical projection of foliage only.
PFC and foliage cover for plants are sensitive to season and drought because foliage may change greatly depending on the water available. This variation is not usually considered in vegetation classification.
Crown cover is the recommended method for reporting cover for plants with discrete crowns and these are usually over about 1.0 m high. Foliage
Table 17 Cover classes can be derived in several ways
CodeCriteria assessed in field Description
Crown separation ratio
Crown cover %a
Foliage cover %a
D Crowns touching to overlapping
Closed or dense <0 >80% >70%
M Crowns touching or slightly separated
Mid-dense 0–0.25 50–80% 30–70%
S Crowns clearly separated
Sparse or open 0.25–1 20–50% 10–30%
V Crowns well separated
Very sparse 1–20 0.25–20% 0.2–10%
I Isolated plants: for trees about 100 m apart, shrubs about 20 m apart
Isolated plants >20 <0.25% <0.20%
L Isolated clumps of 2 to many plants about 200 m apart
Isolated clumps >20 <0.25% <0.20%
E Emergent Emergent >3 <5% of total crown cover
<3% of total foliage cover
a The relationship between crown cover and foliage cover is described in more detail in the text.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 81 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
82
cover can be estimated from crown cover. This approach avoids the problem of variability due to season or water availability. Cover can be estimated both in the field and from large-scale aerial photographs. Crown cover percentage is estimated using the crown separation ratio (CSR) developed by Penridge and Walker (1988) and Walker et al. (1988). However, CSR is not reliable if crowns deviate significantly from circular or slightly oval (e.g. in forests with a significant cover of Corymbia that have very irregular and interlocking shapes).
Ground cover can be estimated by measuring the distance covered by the vertical projection of the leaves and woody branches onto a tape measure and expressing this as a percentage of the total length. This is a line-intercept method.
Cover class for a particular stratum can be quickly assessed based on the crown separation (e.g. touching, well separated). However, because primary data such as actual crown cover percentage are usually more valuable than pre-classified data, a method to accurately estimate the crown separation ratio is needed.
Field estimation of the crown separation ratio for discrete crownsThe CSR is the ratio of the mean gap between crowns and the mean crown width, that is:
CSR = mean gap between crowns/mean crown width.The three steps to estimating CSR in the field are:
1. Sample along a zigzag transect PQ as shown in Figure 5. Start at a crown near P (crown A), and select the next crown encountered going towards or across the transect line, and in the direction P to Q.
2. Measure crown widths and crown gaps for each stratum separately irrespective of species. A mean of 12 measurements is usually sufficient.
3. Where crowns overlap, the crown gap has a negative value; the greater the overlap, the larger the negative value.
The method has been shown by Penridge and Walker (1988) to work well whether crowns are regularly spaced, random or clumped. However, they also note limitations that will apply in some field situations. These are:
CSR should be measured for each stratum separately to avoid situations where crowns overlap.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 82 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Vegetation
83
Crown shapes should approximate circles or non-extreme ellipses. Where crown shapes are so irregular that a near-circular equivalent cannot be determined, an alternative method (e.g. a line-intercept method) should be used to determine cover. For ovoid crowns, average the shortest and longest diameters.The zigzag method of measurement should be used to avoid long distances between trees, which could invalidate the underlying geometric assumptions of the method.
To convert between crown separation ratio and crown cover percentage (Table 18), use the following relationship:
( )CSRk
1Crown cover (%) 2=
+
The constant k = 80.6 for samples taken along a zigzag transect as shown in Figure 5 (Penridge and Walker 1988).
Converting crown cover percentage to foliage coverEstimating crown cover percentage assumes the crown is opaque. Converting crown to foliage cover requires that the degree of crown openness be considered. Crown openness can be assessed by matching the photographs in Figure 6 with actual tree crown types.
Foliage cover percentage = crown cover percentage × crown type.For example:
If CSR is 1.0, crown cover percentage = 20%.If crown openness (Figure 6) is 60%, then:
foliage cover percentage 10020 60 12%#
= =
Ground coverThe ground layer normally comprises low shrubs, grasses, forbs, rushes and sedges and it is necessary, in this classification, to estimate the foliage cover as a vertical projection. For many purposes a visual estimate will suffice to place the ground cover into a cover class (Table 17). Foliage cover of the ground layer may be accurately estimated using point quadrats or foliar intercepts along transects. A rapid field method uses foliar intercepts along a 30 m tape laid out within the sample site (Figure 7).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 83 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
84
(a)
PQ11
109
87
6 5
4
3
2
1A
(b)
PQ
Figu
re 5
The
zig
zag
sam
plin
g pr
oced
ure
is u
sed
for
each
str
atum
or
laye
r, fo
r ex
ampl
e (a
) for
the
dom
inan
t str
atum
or
(b)
for
a m
id-s
trat
um.
Tabl
e 18
Con
vert
ing
crow
n se
para
tion
ratio
to c
row
n co
ver
Cro
wn
sepa
rati
on
rati
o–0
.1–0
.05
–0.0
20
0.05
0.1
0.15
0.2
0.25
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.75
11.
251.
52
34
810
1520
30
Cro
wn
cove
r (%
)10
089
8481
7367
6056
5248
4134
3126
2016
139
53
10.
60.
30.
20.
1
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 84 4/02/09 12:05:24 PM
Vegetation
85
Figure 6 Crown types. Estimate the openness of individual tree or shrub crowns by matching the crown with a photograph. The rows show similar crown types for different leaf size (large to small, left to right). Acacia phyllodes are in the right-hand column. Most Australian woody plants are in the range 40–70%.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 85 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
86
The method is intended for use in grass and low shrubs. Looking vertically down onto the tape and foliage, the amount of foliage intercepted along the tape is estimated, and expressed as a percentage of the transect length. It is easiest to estimate and record the amount of foliage intercepted per metre of tape and to add these amounts at the completion of the transect.
Two to four transects are usually needed per site depending on cover variability. For grass, a 10 m transect is usually enough; for small shrubs, 20 m. A longer transect will be needed where the ground layer is more patchy. In some situations – for example rangeland environments where the formation class may require subdivision – it is often useful to collect information about basal area and/or plant density and to record several cover classes in the <10% foliage cover class. Transects should be located independently of the ground layer so that the sample is not biased. The starting point and direction can be fixed in relation to some aspect of the plot or can be determined by using random numbers to locate the starting point and bearing.
Cover–abundance combines cover and abundance to estimate the quantity of each species in a vegetation sample. For cover values greater than 5%, the scale is a measure of cover (see above). For cover values less than 5%, it measures abundance (i.e. the number of individuals in a defined area).
The Braun-Blanquet cover–abundance scale (Table 19) is widely used. It is simple to use and produces estimates of cover–abundance that are robust for most vegetation classifications. The system is based on the fact that vegetation is often highly variable and so it is more useful to have many samples to show this variation than to have few precise and time-consuming measures.
22cm intercept 20 cm intercept
52cm intercept in 250cm = 20.8%
10 cm intercept
0 2.5 10m
Figure 7 Field measurement of foliage cover using a line transect. The length of intercepted foliage is measured along a tape and foliage cover is calculated as a percentage of the total length of the transect.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 86 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Vegetation
87
Record the cover class code values for the class that represents each species at the sample site.
For the less dense cover classes, imagine moving all individuals into one area and compare that with a reference for the sample site. For example, if the sample site is 400 m2, 5% of the area is 20 m2 (4 m × 5 m), and 1% is 4 m2 (2 m × 2 m).
Although this method provides an absolute value for classes 2–5 (i.e. it is a percentage of a defined sample area), the class boundaries are wide and cover is estimated, not measured. Many studies have shown large variations between observers, as well as in one observer’s estimates at different times. Because of these inherent errors, it is important to regularly compare observers if more than one person is making records and to check observations if one person is recording.
In broad-ranging surveys, it is usually better to have large numbers of samples with good cover–abundance estimates, rather than a few precise measures that do not span the range in variation of the vegetation. If the objectives of the survey are narrowly focused and looking for fine levels of discrimination between samples or sampling times (e.g. site-based monitoring), then actual quantitative measurements are more appropriate than class values.
Table 19 The Braun-Blanquet cover–abundance scale for estimating species quantities (after Mueller-Dombois and Ellenberg (1974))
Code Description Crown cover percentage
5 Any number of plants covering more than ¾ of the sample site
>75%
4 Any number of plants covering from ½ to ¾ of the sample site
50–75%
3 Any number of plants covering ¼ to ½ of the sample site
25–50%
2 Any number of plants covering from 1/20 to ¼ of the sample site
5–25%
1 Many individuals that cover <1/20 of the sample site, or scattered with cover up to 1/20 of the sample site
<5%
+ (pronounced ‘cross’) Few individuals with small cover
Insignificant cover
r Single individual with small cover Insignificant cover
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 87 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
88
STRUCTURAL FORMATION (LEVEL 2)Growth formAt Level 1, only two life forms exist (woody plants or non-woody plants). In contrast, at Level 2, many more detailed categories of growth forms are used. The term growth form is used in a broad sense to describe the form or shape of individual plants (e.g. tree, shrub) or Australian broad floristic land cover types (e.g. native vegetation such as mallee, chenopod shrub; or non-native vegetation such as wheat fields, orchards). The following glossary (modified from ESCAVI 2003 and alphabetised by growth form name) defines the growth forms for structural formations.
Growth form Code Definition
Algae: fresh or brackish
a3.0 a member of the Chlorophyta, Cyanophyta, Phaeophyta or Rhodophyta living in fresh or brackish aquatic environments.
Algae: marine a4.0 a member of the Chlorophyta, Cyanophyta, Phaeophyta or Rhodophyta living in marine environments. May range from thin surface-hugging layers to tall algal forests.
Aquatic higher plants
a1.0 (or w) dicotyledonous or monocotyledonous plants growing for a significant portion of their life cycle in fresh or brackish water. (For convenience, this may include various woody vegetation such as mangroves, eucalypt, melaleuca or other woody, periodically submerged vegetation, which span saline aquatic environments from brackish to hypersaline. The code used (a1.0 or w) will depend on the particular emphases of the survey.)
Bare surface b1.0 soil, rock or water surfaces with less than 0.5% plant cover.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 88 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Vegetation
89
Bryophyte m1.0 a member of the Division Bryophyta (i.e. mosses and liverworts). Mosses are small plants usually with a slender leaf-bearing stem with no true vascular tissue. Liverworts often appear moss-like or consist of a flat, ribbon-like, green thallus.
Chenopod shrub
w3.2 single-stemmed or multi-stemmed, semi-succulent shrub of the family Chenopodiaceae exhibiting drought and salt tolerance.
Cryptogam cryptogam refers collectively to lichens and bryophytes.
Fern (excluding tree ferns)
f1.0 a member of the Division Pterophyta (i.e. ferns and fern allies). Characterised by large and usually branched leaves (fronds); herbaceous and terrestrial to aquatic; spores in sporangia on the undersides of leaves. Tree ferns are classified with woody plants as they have the same vegetation structure.
Food see Shrub: planted/cultivated (food) or Tree: planted/cultivated (food).
Forb h1.0 non-graminoid herbaceous plant.
Grass g1.0 member of the family Poaceae.
Grass: planted/cultivated
g4.0 member of the Poaceae planted or cultivated for specific human uses (e.g. human or other animal food, lawn or other ground cover).
Grass: planted/cultivated (pasture)
g4.1 member of the Poaceae cultivated or maintained for the production of food for animals, whether harvested or grazed directly.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 89 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
90
Grass: planted/cultivated (cereals)
g4.2 member of the Poaceae cultivated as cereal food for human consumption.
Grass: planted/cultivated (other industrial)
g4.3 member of Poaceae cultivated or maintained for industrial purposes but not for food (e.g. turf farm for lawn-grasses, road batten stabilisation).
Heath or kwongan or wallum shrub
w3.1 shrub usually less than 2 m tall, commonly with ericoid leaves (nanophyll, less than 225 mm2). Often a member of one of the following families: Epacridaceae, Myrtaceae, Fabaceae and Proteaceae. Commonly occur on nutrient-poor substrates.
Herb h2.0 herbaceous or slightly woody, annual or sometimes perennial plant (dicotyledon or monocotyledon).
Herb: planted/cultivated (perennial, non-food)
h2.1 planted/cultivated perennial herbaceous plant (monocotyledon or dicotyledon); non-food.
Herb: planted/cultivated (annual, non-food)
h2.2 planted/cultivated annual herbaceous plant (monocotyledon or dicotyledon); non-food.
Herb: planted/cultivated (perennial, food)
h2.3 planted/cultivated perennial herbaceous plant (monocotyledon or dicotyledon); food.
Herb: planted/cultivated (annual, food)
h2.4 planted/cultivated annual herbaceous plant (monocotyledon or dicotyledon); food.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 90 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Vegetation
91
Hummock grass g2.0 coarse xeromorphic grass with a mound-like form often dead in the middle; genera are Triodia, Plectrachne and Zygochloa.
Lichen l1.0 composite plant consisting of a fungus living symbiotically with algae or cyanobacteria; without true roots, stems or leaves.
Mallee (tree or shrub)
w2.1 any of the eucalypt trees or shrubs with multiple stems arising from a lignotuber.
Rainforest see Tree: rainforest.
Rush g6.0 herbaceous, usually perennial, erect monocot that is neither a grass nor a sedge. For the purpose of this chapter, rushes include the monocotyledon families Juncaceae, Typhaceae, Liliaceae, Iridaceae, Xyridaceae and the genus Lomandra, i.e. ‘graminoid’ or grass-like genera.
Samphire shrub w3.3 a subdivision of chenopod shrubs. Genera (of Tribe Salicornioideae, namely Halosarcia, Pachycornia, Sarcocornia, Sclerostegia, Tecticornia and Tegicornia) with articulate branches, fleshy stems and reduced flowers within the Chenopodiaceae family; succulent chenopods. Also the genus Suaeda.
Seagrass: marine
a2.0 genera and species of flowering angiosperms of the families Hydrocharitaceae and Potamogetonaceae, forming sparse to dense mats of material at the subtidal level and down to 30 m below mean sea level. Occasionally exposed.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 91 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
92
Sedge g5.0 herbaceous, usually perennial, erect plant generally with a tufted habit and of the families Cyperaceae (true sedges) or Restionaceae (node sedges).
Shrub w3.0 woody plant, multi-stemmed at the base (or within about 200 mm from ground level), or, if single-stemmed, less than about 5 m tall; not always readily distinguishable from small trees.
Shrub: planted/cultivated (food)
w3.4 shrubs planted in rows for the production of food crops.
Shrub: planted/cultivated (non-food)
w3.5 shrubs planted in mostly urban/suburban settings such as gardens, along streets, and nurseries.
Surface crusts c1.0 assemblages of one or more species of minute plants at or within the surface of soil or rock. May consist of bryophytes, lichens, cyanobacteria, green algae and fungi; may in some cases include very small vascular plants.
Tree w1.0 woody plant more than 2 m tall usually with a single stem, or branches well above the base; not always distinguishable from large shrubs.
Tree: rainforest w1.1 no widely accepted or universal definition for Australian rainforests. Usually distinguished by their dark green colour and species composition, which contrasts with the surrounding grey or reddish-green and often eucalypt-dominated vegetation.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 92 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Vegetation
93
Tree: planted/cultivated (non-food)
w1.2 trees planted in rows for the intense production of non-food crops.
Tree: planted/cultivated (food)
w1.3 trees planted in rows for the production of food crops.
Tree: planted/cultivated (landscaping)
w1.4 trees planted in mostly urban/suburban settings (e.g. gardens, along streets, and nurseries).
Tussock grass g3.0 grasses forming discrete but open tufts usually with distinct individual shoots. These include the common agricultural grasses.
Vine v1.0 climbing, twining, winding or sprawling plants usually with a woody stem.
Woody plant (indeterminate tree or shrub)
w2.0 plants with woody tissues. For the purposes of vegetation classification here, also those plants that achieve a growth form similar to that of woody plants (e.g. cycads, palms, tree ferns). Includes both trees and shrubs.
Cover and crown typeAt Level 2, cover and crown type are classified as described for Level 1 in the section ‘Cover and crown type’ (page 80).
HeightIn the field, height should be measured, rather than the height class estimated. Height can be measured using measuring tapes or poles for low vegetation. Clinometers, laser or sonic ranging instruments, visual sighting instruments or LIDAR can be used for tall vegetation (see Brack 1998; Abed and Stephens 2003). Inaccuracy in measurements increases as crown closure and height increases.
Record the height from the ground to the highest part of the plant above ground. Where the height of flower stalks (e.g. in grasses, grass trees) or leaves
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 93 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
94
(e.g. in palms, cycads, grass trees, tree ferns) add significantly to plant height and contribute significantly to a stratum, then record two measurements: total height from ground level to the top of the highest part of the plant, and height from ground level to the top of the leaves (e.g. Xanthorrhoea johnsonii 2.5 m/1.3 m; Sorghum intrans 1.9 m/1.3 m). This provides an accurate record and allows various uses in analysis.
The recorded heights can then be converted to height classes as shown in Table 20.
Foliage cover of the lower stratumUse the methods described in the section ‘Cover and crown type’ (page 80) to classify the foliage cover of the lower stratum.
EmergentsSome plants can rise above the level of the dominant stratum and because their total cover is small, they are considered to be emergents rather than a separate stratum. As a guideline, emergents are recognised if their foliage cover is less than 5% of the crown cover of the dominant stratum (see Figure 8 for a tree example). Care is needed in classifying tall plants as emergents, and the 5% guideline can be expected to vary depending on vegetation type and season – especially if the ground layer is the dominant stratum. In some borderline cases, taller plants can occur over a lower stratum that elsewhere forms the dominant stratum of a well-known vegetation type. In this situation it is acceptable to continue to call the tallest stratum emergents where it is considered unhelpful to create a new vegetation type solely on the basis of the unusually slightly higher cover of the tallest plants.
Record the total crown cover percentage, median height and/or maximum height, and the genus (and species if possible) of the emergent layer. Measure height and cover as for other plant attributes described earlier.
When the tallest stratum is not the most significant stratum, the guidelines vary for different kinds of vegetation as follows.
Where the vegetation is dominated by trees or shrubs, and the tallest layer emerges above a dominant canopy (i.e. cover >5%) and has generally less than 5% total cover, then the tallest trees or shrubs are called emergents. The genus or species of emergents should be recorded, if possible, followed by the word ‘emergents’ (e.g. ‘with hoop pine emergents’; ‘with Araucaria emergents’; ‘with Eucalyptus emergents’).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 94 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Vegetation
95
Where the vegetation is dominated by perennial grasses, for example Triodia, and a taller layer of woody plants emerges above it with less than 5% of the Triodia cover, then the tallest plants are called emergents and should be named as in the example above.Where the vegetation is seasonally or sporadically dominated by annual plants in a mix of perennial plants that form a taller layer, then in most cases the dominant layer is the taller perennial layer. For example, ‘sparse eucalypt trees with seasonally dominant Sorghum in the understorey’ or ‘sparse acacia trees with periodically dominant annual herbs of Asteraceae and other families’.For ephemeral wetlands, where the dominant layer is present only periodically and there is no taller woody layer, the dominant layer is the ephemeral layer. It is recorded as ephemeral (e.g. ‘ephemeral mixed herbs’).
BROAD FLORISTIC FORMATION (LEVEL 3) AND SUBDIVISIONS (LEVELS 4 TO 6)A species or genus name (shown as ‘X’ in Table 21, see page 98) is added to the structural formation name of Level 2 to give Level 3, the broad floristic
Table 20 Height classes, codes and names
Height class code Height (m)
Life form w (woody plants)
Life form nw (non-woody plants)
10 >50.01 Giant NAa
9 35.01–50 Extremely tall NA
8 20.01–35 Very tall NA
7 10.01–20 Tall NA
6 5.01–10 Medium Giant
5 2.01–5.0 Low Extremely tall
4 1.01–2 Dwarf Very tall
3 0.51–1 Miniature Tall
2 0.26–0.5 Micro Medium
1 0.05–0.25 Nano Low
0 <0.05 NA Dwarf
a NA, not applicable.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 95 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
96
formation. For Level 3, only the dominant species in the dominant stratum is used. More species names can be added to this stratum or to lower strata to distinguish vegetation types (and these added details result in levels conceptually equivalent to the more detailed levels IV–VI in NVIS). The method can be summarised as follows:
First species: Select the most abundant or physically predominant species in the dominant stratum.Second species: If a second species is always present and conspicuous in the dominant stratum (a co-dominant species) then add that species to the name. If a co-dominant species is not present, select the most abundant or physically predominant species of the next most conspicuous stratum.Third species: Select an indicator species, or a species that distinguishes a particular vegetation association. This may be in any stratum, but is usually in a lower stratum. This species will have known environmental preferences and will be conspicuously abundant.Subsequent species: In some cases more species are required to separate subassociations; select as for the third species.
The species selected in the field can be modified later based on numerical analysis or to conform to an agreed list of vegetation types. The main problem with using the dominant species to qualify the structural formation is that dominance can vary spatially. Due care needs to be given to adequately sample representative areas. Given adequate sampling, this problem, however, is best resolved after the field survey is completed and various descriptions have been tried. Ideally, all species present in the sample site at the time of sampling should be recorded. As a minimum, the dominant species in each stratum should be recorded.
Species codesA code using the first two letters of the genus and the first three letters of the species is more convenient than writing names in full. For the few species with the same code, replace the last letter with a number. Some people use four letters for genus and four letters for species to avoid sequences that may be confusing; others use a ‘pick list’ to record full scientific names. Examples of floristic codes are:
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 96 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Vegetation
97
EUPOP Eucalyptus populnea (dominant species in dominant stratum)
ERMIT Eremophila mitchellii (dominant species in mid-stratum)
BODEC Bothriochloa decipiens (dominant species in lower stratum)
ERGLA Eremophila glabra
ERGL2 Eremocitrus glauca
FloristicsFloristics is the list of plant species found at a sample site. Record the name of each species, native and non-native, unless a list of what to include or exclude has been defined for your project. It is preferable to use the full scientific name to avoid ambiguities and to make it easier to combine datasets. If using ad hoc species names, ensure that voucher specimens are collected and records are updated with scientific names.
Each State and Territory maintains comprehensive lists of plant species. The major State, Territory and national herbaria have established the Australian Plant Census to produce a national list of scientific names with major synonyms. This Census will contain the names used in Australia’s Virtual Herbarium (2007).
Comprehensive species lists prepared by State and Territory environment departments or herbaria are available for some vegetation types and parts of Australia. These lists should be used as part of the field recording proforma to speed recording and to direct attention to unusual species records requiring detailed notes and possibly voucher specimens or photographs. Prepare this list as an initial checklist.
Flora of Australia (Commonwealth of Australia 2007) is available online, as are State-level identification tools. Interactive multi-entry digital keys to major plant groups are available and more can be expected. Specimens should be collected to provide reference material to verify or confirm species identifications, or as tools to help ensure consistent identifications between workers and over time.
It is not always necessary to collect plant specimens, especially at the formation and structural formation levels. However, good field-based floristic work is based on the following practices:
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 97 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
98
Tabl
e 21
Bro
ad fl
oris
tic fo
rmat
ions
(Lev
el 3
)a
Cov
er c
hara
cter
isti
cs
Folia
ge
cove
r (%
)10
0–7
070
–30
30–1
010
–0.2
<0.
2<
0.2
<3b
Cro
wn
cove
r (%
)>
8080
–50
50–2
020
–0.2
5<
0.25
<0.
25<
5b
Cro
wn
sepa
ra-
tion
ratio
<0
0–0
.25
0.25
–11–
20>
20>
20>
3
Cov
er
code
&
nam
e
D Clo
sed
or
dens
e
M Mid
-den
seS Sp
arse
or
open
V Ver
y sp
arse
I Isol
ated
pl
ants
L Isol
ated
clu
mps
E Emer
gent
s
Gro
wth
fo
rm
code
c
Gro
wth
for
m
of d
omin
ant
stra
tum
dH
eigh
t ra
nge
(m)
Bro
ad f
lori
stic
form
atio
n cl
asse
se
w1.
0Tr
ee2–
50C
lose
d X
tr
ees
Mid
-den
se X
tr
ees
Spar
se X
tr
ees
Ver
y sp
arse
X
tree
sIs
olat
ed X
tr
ees
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X tr
ees
X tr
ees
w1.
1Tr
ee:
rain
fore
st2–
50C
lose
d X
tr
ees
Mid
-den
se X
tr
ees
Spar
se X
tr
ees
Ver
y sp
arse
X
tree
sIs
olat
ed X
tr
ees
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X tr
ees
X tr
ees
w1.
2Tr
ee:
plan
ted
/ cu
ltiva
ted
(non
-foo
d)
2–50
Clo
sed
X
tree
sM
id-d
ense
X
tree
sSp
arse
X
tree
sV
ery
spar
se
X tr
ees
Isol
ated
X
tree
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
tree
sX
tree
s
w1.
3Tr
ee:
plan
ted
/ cu
ltiva
ted
(food
)
2–50
Clo
sed
X
tree
sM
id-d
ense
X
tree
sSp
arse
X
tree
sV
ery
spar
se
X tr
ees
Isol
ated
X
tree
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
tree
sX
tree
s
w1.
4Tr
ee:
plan
ted
/ cu
ltiva
ted
(land
s cap
ing)
2–50
Clo
sed
X
tree
sM
id-d
ense
X
tree
sSp
arse
X
tree
sV
ery
spar
se
X tr
ees
Isol
ated
X
tree
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
tree
sX
tree
s
w2
.0W
oody
pla
nt
(inde
term
i-na
te tr
ee o
r sh
rub)
0.1–
10C
lose
d X
w
oody
pl
ants
Mid
-den
se X
w
oody
pla
nts
Spar
se X
w
oody
pl
ants
Ver
y sp
arse
X
woo
dy
plan
ts
Isol
ated
X
woo
dy
plan
ts
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X w
oody
pl
ants
X w
oody
pl
ants
w2
.1M
alle
e (tr
ee
or s
hrub
)0.
1–30
Clo
sed
X
mal
lee
Mid
-den
se X
m
alle
e Sp
arse
X
mal
lee
Ver
y sp
arse
X
mal
lee
Isol
ated
X
mal
lee
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X m
alle
e X
mal
lee
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 98 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Vegetation
99
w3.
0Sh
rub
<20
Clo
sed
X
shru
bsM
id-d
ense
X
shru
bsSp
arse
X
shru
bsV
ery
spar
se
X s
hrub
sIs
olat
ed X
sh
rubs
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X s
hrub
sX
shr
ubs
w3.
1H
eath
or
kwon
gan
or
wal
lum
shr
ub
<8
Clo
sed
X
heat
h sh
rubs
Mid
-den
se X
he
ath
shru
bsSp
arse
X
heat
h sh
rubs
Ver
y sp
arse
X
hea
th
shru
bs
Isol
ated
X
heat
h sh
rubs
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X h
eath
sh
rubs
X h
eath
sh
rubs
w3.
2C
heno
pod
shru
b<
3C
lose
d X
ch
enop
od
shru
bs
Mid
-den
se X
ch
enop
od
shru
bs
Spar
se X
ch
enop
od
shru
bs
Ver
y sp
arse
X
che
nopo
d sh
rubs
Isol
ated
X
chen
opod
sh
rubs
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X c
heno
pod
shru
bs
X c
heno
pod
shru
bs
w3.
3Sa
mph
ire
shru
b<
3C
lose
d X
sa
mph
ire
shru
bs
Mid
-den
se X
sa
mph
ire
shru
bs
Spar
se X
sa
mph
ire
shru
bs
Ver
y sp
arse
X
sam
phir
e sh
rubs
Isol
ated
X
sam
phir
e sh
rubs
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X s
amph
ire
shru
bs
X s
amph
ire
shru
bs
w3.
4Sh
rub:
pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (fo
od)
<8
Clo
sed
X
food
shr
ubs
Mid
-den
se X
fo
od s
hrub
sSp
arse
X
food
shr
ubs
Ver
y sp
arse
X
food
sh
rubs
Isol
ated
X
food
shr
ubs
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X fo
od s
hrub
sX
food
sh
rubs
w3.
5Sh
rub:
pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (n
on-f
ood)
<10
Clo
sed
X
indu
stria
l sh
rubs
Mid
-den
se X
in
dust
rial
shru
bs
Spar
se X
in
dust
rial
shru
bs
Ver
y sp
arse
X
indu
stria
l sh
rubs
Isol
ated
X
indu
stria
l sh
rubs
Isol
ated
X
indu
stria
l shr
ubs
X in
dust
rial
shru
bs
g1.
0G
rass
0.01
–5C
lose
d X
gr
asse
sM
id-d
ense
X
gras
ses
Spar
se X
gr
asse
sV
ery
spar
se
X g
rass
esIs
olat
ed X
gr
asse
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
gra
sses
X g
rass
es
g2
.0H
umm
ock
gras
s<
2C
lose
d X
hu
mm
ock
gras
ses
Mid
-den
se X
hu
mm
ock
gras
ses
Spar
se X
hu
mm
ock
gras
ses
Ver
y sp
arse
X
hum
moc
k gr
asse
s
Isol
ated
X
hum
moc
k gr
asse
s
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X h
umm
ock
gras
ses
X h
umm
ock
gras
ses
g3.
0Tu
ssoc
k gr
ass
<5
Clo
sed
X
tuss
ock
gras
ses
Mid
-den
se X
tu
ssoc
k gr
asse
s
Spar
se X
tu
ssoc
k gr
asse
s
Ver
y sp
arse
X
tuss
ock
gras
ses
Isol
ated
X
tuss
ock
gras
ses
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X tu
ssoc
k gr
asse
s
X tu
ssoc
k gr
asse
s
g4.
0G
rass
: pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d
<3
Clo
sed
X
gras
ses
Mid
-den
se X
gr
asse
s Sp
arse
X
gras
ses
Ver
y sp
arse
X
gra
sses
Is
olat
ed X
gr
asse
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
gra
sses
X g
rass
es
g4.
1G
rass
: pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (p
astu
re)
<4
Clo
sed
X
past
ure
Mid
-den
se X
pa
stur
eSp
arse
X
past
ure
Ver
y sp
arse
X
pas
ture
Isol
ated
X
past
ure
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X p
astu
reX
pas
ture
g4.
2G
rass
: pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (c
erea
ls)
<5
Clo
sed
X
cere
als
Mid
-den
se X
ce
real
sSp
arse
X
cere
als
Ver
y sp
arse
X
cer
eals
Isol
ated
X
cere
als
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X c
erea
lsX
cer
eals
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 99 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
100
Gro
wth
fo
rm
code
c
Gro
wth
for
m
of d
omin
ant
stra
tum
dH
eigh
t ra
nge
(m)
Bro
ad f
lori
stic
form
atio
n cl
asse
se
g4.
3G
rass
: pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (o
ther
in
dust
rial)
<3
Clo
sed
X
gras
ses
Mid
-den
se X
gr
asse
sSp
arse
X
gras
ses
Ver
y sp
arse
X
gra
sses
Isol
ated
X
gras
ses
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X g
rass
esX
gra
sses
g5.
0Se
dge
<3
Clo
sed
X
sedg
esM
id-d
ense
X
sedg
esSp
arse
X
sedg
esV
ery
spar
se
X s
edge
sIs
olat
ed X
se
dges
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X s
edge
sX
sed
ges
g6.
0Ru
sh<
3C
lose
d X
ru
shes
Mid
-den
se X
ru
shes
Spar
se X
ru
shes
Ver
y sp
arse
X
rus
hes
Isol
ated
X
rush
esIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
rus
hes
X r
ushe
s
h1.0
Forb
<2
Clo
sed
X
forb
sM
id-d
ense
X
forb
sSp
arse
X
forb
sV
ery
spar
se
X fo
rbs
Isol
ated
X
forb
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
forb
sX
forb
s
h2
.0H
erb
<2
Clo
sed
X
herb
sM
id-d
ense
X
herb
sSp
arse
X
herb
sV
ery
spar
se
X h
erbs
Isol
ated
X
herb
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
her
bsX
her
bs
h2
.1H
erb:
pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (p
eren
nial
, no
n-fo
od)
<2
Clo
sed
X
herb
sM
id-d
ense
X
herb
sSp
arse
X
herb
sV
ery
spar
se
X h
erbs
Isol
ated
X
herb
s Is
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
her
bs
X h
erbs
h2
.2H
erb:
pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (a
nnua
l, no
n-fo
od)
<2
Clo
sed
X
herb
sM
id-d
ense
X
herb
sSp
arse
X
herb
sV
ery
spar
se
X h
erbs
Isol
ated
X
herb
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
her
bsX
her
bs
h2
.3H
erb:
pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (p
eren
nial
, fo
od)
<2
Clo
sed
X
herb
sM
id-d
ense
X
herb
sSp
arse
X
herb
sV
ery
spar
se
X h
erbs
Isol
ated
X
herb
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
her
bsX
her
bs
h2
.4H
erb:
pl
ante
d/
culti
vate
d (a
nnua
l, fo
od)
<2
Clo
sed
X
herb
sM
id-d
ense
X
herb
sSp
arse
X
herb
sV
ery
spar
se
X h
erbs
Isol
ated
X
herb
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
her
bsX
her
bs
Tabl
e 21
(con
t.)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 100 4/02/09 12:05:25 PM
Vegetation
101
f1.0
Fern
(e
xclu
ding
tr
ee fe
rns)
<2
Clo
sed
X
fern
sM
id-d
ense
X
fern
sSp
arse
X
fern
sV
ery
spar
se
X fe
rns
Isol
ated
X
fern
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
fern
sX
fern
s
m1.
0B
ryop
hyte
<2
Clo
sed
X
bryo
phyt
esM
id-d
ense
X
bryo
phyt
esSp
arse
X
bryo
phyt
esV
ery
spar
se
X
bryo
phyt
es
Isol
ated
X
bryo
phyt
esIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
bry
ophy
tes
X b
ryop
hyte
s
l1.0
Lich
en<
5C
lose
d X
lic
hens
Mid
-den
se X
lic
hens
Spar
se X
lic
hens
Ver
y sp
arse
X
lich
ens
Isol
ated
X
liche
nsIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
lich
ens
X li
chen
s
c1.0
Surf
ace
crus
ts
<0.
05C
lose
d X
cr
usts
Mid
-den
se X
cr
usts
Spar
se X
cr
usts
Ver
y sp
arse
X
cru
sts
Isol
ated
X
crus
tsIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
cru
sts
X c
rust
s
v1.0
Vin
e0.
5–30
Clo
sed
X
vine
sM
id-d
ense
X
vine
sSp
arse
X
vine
sV
ery
spar
se
X v
ines
Isol
ated
X
vine
sIs
olat
ed c
lum
ps
of X
vin
esX
vin
es
a1.0
Aqu
atic
hi
gher
pla
nts
<2
Clo
sed
X
aqua
tic
plan
ts
Mid
-den
se X
aq
uatic
pla
nts
Spar
se X
aq
uatic
pl
ants
Ver
y sp
arse
X
aqu
atic
pl
ants
Isol
ated
X
aqua
tic
plan
ts
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X a
quat
ic
plan
ts
X a
quat
ic
plan
ts
a2
.0Se
agra
ss:
mar
ine
<2
Clo
sed
X
seag
rass
es
Mid
-den
se X
se
agra
sses
Spar
se X
se
agra
sses
Ver
y sp
arse
X
sea
gras
ses
Isol
ated
X
seag
rass
es
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X s
eagr
asse
sX
sea
gras
ses
a3.
0A
lgae
: fre
sh
or b
rack
ish
Rec
ord
thic
k-ne
ss
of la
yer
Clo
sed
X
alga
e M
id-d
ense
X
alga
e Sp
arse
X
alga
e V
ery
spar
se
X a
lgae
Is
olat
ed X
al
gae
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X a
lgae
X
alg
ae
a4.
0A
lgae
: m
arin
e<
30C
lose
d X
m
arin
e al
gae
Mid
-den
se X
m
arin
e al
gae
Spar
se X
m
arin
e al
gae
Ver
y sp
arse
X
mar
ine
alga
e
Isol
ated
X
mar
ine
alga
e
Isol
ated
clu
mps
of
X m
arin
e al
gae
X m
arin
e al
gae
b1.0
Bar
e su
rfac
eB
are
grou
ndf
a Fo
r co
nsis
tenc
y in
nam
ing
broa
d flo
rist
ic fo
rmat
ion
clas
ses
in th
is ta
ble,
two
chan
ges
to W
alke
r an
d H
opki
ns (1
990
) hav
e oc
curr
ed: t
he te
rms
‘fore
st’ a
nd
‘woo
dlan
d’ h
ave
been
rep
lace
d w
ith ‘t
rees
’, an
d th
e su
ffix
‘lan
d’ h
as b
een
rem
oved
.b
For
emer
gent
s, ‘<
3’ m
eans
‘up
to 3
% o
f tot
al fo
liage
cov
er’ a
nd ‘<
5’ m
eans
‘up
to 5
% o
f the
tota
l cro
wn
cove
r’.c
Cel
ls s
hade
d gr
ey in
this
col
umn
are
woo
dy li
fe fo
rms
(w) w
hile
the
unsh
aded
cel
ls a
re n
on-w
oody
life
form
s (n
w).
d Se
e pa
ge 8
8 fo
r de
finiti
ons
of g
row
th fo
rms.
e In
eac
h cl
ass
nam
e, r
epla
ce th
e ‘X
’ with
the
taxo
nom
ic n
ame
from
eith
er th
e do
min
ant g
enus
or
genu
s gr
oup
mak
ing
up th
e do
min
ant s
trat
um. N
ot a
ll cl
asse
s re
quir
e a
sepa
rate
taxo
nom
ic n
ame
(e.g
. mid
-den
se m
alle
e). I
n ot
her
case
s th
e ‘X
’ nam
e is
opt
iona
l, fo
r ex
ampl
e sp
arse
che
nopo
d sh
rubs
ver
sus
spar
se A
trip
lex
chen
opod
shr
ubs
or s
pars
e A
trip
lex
shru
bs.
f Th
e cl
asse
s fo
r ba
re s
urfa
ce a
re d
elib
erat
ely
not g
iven
a n
ame
but c
an b
e co
ded.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 101 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
102
Ensure that appropriate collecting permits and/or permissions are obtained before collecting. Each State/Territory/Commonwealth has its own regulations and procedures. In many instances these can be accessed from web pages of the relevant authority.Know what constitutes an adequate specimen for the various types of plants you will encounter. Contact your local or State/Territory herbarium, or an experienced field collector, for advice if need be. Guidelines are also available from various websites.Know what rare flora may be encountered, how to identify it and what to do if any are found. There may be limits on collecting such material. Photographs may suffice as records for rare flora.Record in a field notebook, especially maintained for plant collections, the basic information for voucher specimens: plant name, location where collected (geocoordinates, distance/direction from known geographic feature), date, collector and collector’s number, habitat (e.g. soil, vegetation type), plant height, phenological state (e.g. flowering, fruiting, leafing, dormant, colours of plant parts).Tag each specimen, recording the collector’s name/initials and field number, which should be unique to the collector or the project and which will also be recorded on the field data sheets.Preserve the plants by drying in a plant press. Some types of plants may need special treatment (e.g. mosses, lichens, fungi, algae, aquatic plants, succulents, very large plants/leaves).If using field names and ID numbers, ensure subsequent updating of records when formal identification is complete.Where possible, arrange to deposit voucher specimens in an appropriate herbarium. Voucher collections can be of two types. The first type is a reference set for field workers. This collection may be taken into the field and consists only of snippets of relevant plant parts, or scanned and printed images of such plants, to aid in field identification. The second type of voucher collection is deposited in a herbarium; higher collecting and recording standards may then apply.
EXAMPLES OF STANDARD CLASSIFICATIONAs seen in Table 14, the first step in a standard classification is identifying the strata. The attributes for each stratum are then measured in the field as described earlier in this chapter; each level of classification requires the
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 102 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
103
attributes as listed in Table 14. Once these data are gathered, the vegetation type in each stratum can be named and coded as shown in Figure 8. Multiple strata can be named and coded following the sequence: upper stratum height/cover/growth form; mid-stratum or strata height/cover/growth form; ground stratum height/cover/growth form.
For the example shown in Figure 8, a hypothetical site with four strata and emergent trees is used. The full names and codes at four different levels of classification are as follows:
Formation (Level 1)
Name: ‘Mid-dense woody plants’
Code: Mw
Structural formation (Level 2)
Name: ‘Emergent very tall trees with very tall mid-dense trees’
Code: E8w1.0 /8Mw1.0
Broad floristic formation (Level 3)
Name: ‘Emergent very tall Angophora with very tall mid-dense Eucalyptus trees’
Code: E8Angophoraw1.0 /8MEucalyptusw1.0
Broad floristic subformation (Level 4)
Name: ‘Emergent very tall Angophora trees over very tall mid-dense Eucalyptus trees with tall sparse Eucalyptus tree understorey over dwarf very sparse Eremophila shrubs with a tall sparse Bothriochloa tussock grass ground stratum’
Code: E8Angophoraw1.0 /8MEucalyptusw1.0 /7SEucalyptusw1.0
/4VEremophilaw3.0 /3SBothriochloag3.0
Further detail may be added. For example, some vegetation types such as wetlands or rainforests may require additional attributes, or the surveyor might wish to assess the growth stage or condition of the vegetation.
WETLANDSWetlands are defined by the Ramsar Convention (Anon. 1994) as ‘… areas of marsh, fen, peatland or water, whether natural or artificial, permanent or
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 103 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
104
temporary, with water that is static or flowing, fresh, brackish or salt, including areas of marine water the depth of which at low tide does not exceed six metres’.
Some wetland vegetation types overlap with dryland vegetation types while other types are unique. The presence or degree of inundation may not always be discernable at the time of sampling.
Ephemeral and periodic wetlands pose recording issues similar to those of ephemeral annual dryland plants. Because changes that affect vegetation structure, cover, height and floristic composition are much faster than for most dryland sites, special sampling programs are required to record the essential aspects of wetlands.
If the wetland is ephemeral, intermittent or fluctuating, field workers may not be able to identify the plants’ growth form at the time of sampling. In such cases, record the plants as they are seen and indicate whether the site appears to be a wetland and whether the water level appears to be changing.
Record the type of wetland as per those listed later in this chapter in ‘Aquatic and wetland types’ and the dominant growth forms as per Table 22.
A
E
E
B
C
Upper (U)
Mid-stratum 1 (M1)
Mid-stratum 2 (M2)Ground (G)D
Emergent (E)
Figure 8 A hypothetical site with four strata (top heights A, B, C and D) and emergent trees (top height E). Refer to text (page 103) and the table opposite for the full codes and names at four levels of classification for this example.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 104 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
105
Figu
re 8
(co
nt.)
Top
heig
htE
AB
CD
Stra
tum
nam
e (c
ode)
Emer
gent
(E
)D
omin
ant s
trat
um
(U)
Mid
-str
atum
1
(M1)
Mid
-str
atum
2
(M2
)G
roun
d st
ratu
m
(G)
Life
form
a (c
ode)
Woo
dy p
lant
s
(w)
Woo
dy p
lant
s
(w)
Woo
dy p
lant
s
(w)
Woo
dy p
lant
s
(w)
Non
-woo
dy p
lant
s (n
w)
Cro
wn
cove
rb3%
67%
22%
13%
25%
Cro
wn
sepa
ratio
n ra
tiob
(nam
e,
code
)
4.0
(em
erge
nt, E
)0.
1 (m
id-d
ense
, M)
0.9
(spa
rse,
S)
1.5
(ver
y sp
arse
, V)
0.8
(spa
rse,
S)
Gro
wth
form
c (c
ode)
Tree
(w1.
0)
Tree
(w1.
0)
Tree
(w1.
0)
Shru
b (w
3.0)
Tuss
ock
gras
s (g
3.0
)
Hei
ghtd
(nam
e, c
ode)
28 m
(ver
y ta
ll, 8
)21
m (v
ery
tall,
8)
11 m
(tal
l, 7)
2 m
(dw
arf,
4)0.
7 m
(tal
l, 3
)
Des
crip
tionc
Emer
gent
ver
y ta
ll tr
ees
Ver
y ta
ll m
id-d
ense
tr
ees
Tall
spar
se tr
ees
Dw
arf v
ery
spar
se
shru
bsTa
ll sp
arse
tuss
ock
gras
ses
Gen
us o
r sp
ecie
sA
ngop
hora
Euca
lypt
usEu
caly
ptus
Erem
ophi
laB
othr
ioch
loa
Bro
ad fl
oris
tic
form
atio
n (L
evel
3) f
ull
code
E8A
ngop
hora
w1.
08M
Euc
alyp
tusw
1.0
Bro
ad fl
oris
tic
subf
orm
atio
n (L
evel
4) f
ull
code
E8A
ngop
hora
w1.
08M
Euc
alyp
tusw
1.0
7SEuc
alyp
tusw
1.0
4VEre
mop
hila
w3.
03S
Bothr
ioch
loag
3.0
a Se
e ‘L
ife
form
’, pa
ge 8
0.b
See
Tabl
e 17
and
Tab
le 1
8.c
See
‘Gro
wth
form
’ (pa
ge 8
8) a
nd T
able
21.
d
See
Tabl
e 20
.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 105 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
106
Wetland-specific sampling methods may be found in Anderson (1999) and Brock and Casanova (2000).
Use site observations (especially at planned times of year or relative to drought–non-drought cycles), aerial photographs and maps. Brock and Casanova (2000) provide detailed methods for sampling in wetlands.
The method presented here allows the major types of wetlands to be identified. Additional attributes would be needed for detailed analysis of wetlands.
Aquatic and wetland typesThe 40 aquatic and wetland types listed here are taken from the Directory of important wetlands in Australia (Commonwealth of Australia 2001). The definition of wetland is consistent with that adopted by the Ramsar Convention, Article 1.1 (Anon. 1994). Marine vegetation below 6 m depth is not covered in this manual.
A – Marine and coastal zone wetlands
1 Marine waters – permanent shallow waters less than 6 m deep at low tide; includes sea bays, straits
2 Subtidal aquatic beds; includes kelp beds, seagrasses, tropical marine meadows
Table 22 Wetland growth forms
Code Type Notes
1 Emergent, permanent Woody or herbaceous, not ephemeral
2 Emergent, ephemeral Herbaceous, ephemeral
3 Floating stems with leaves at the surface but roots in substrate
Herbaceous, leaves at surface
4 Floating mats Predominantly herbaceous (e.g. grass mats not attached to substrate)
5 Fully submerged with roots attached to substrate
Herbaceous with whole plant below surface; in some cases flowers may be emergent
6 Fully submerged, floating Unattached plant, submerged (e.g. free-floating herbs or algae)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 106 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
107
3 Coral reefs
4 Rocky marine shores; includes rocky offshore islands, sea cliffs
5 Sand, shingle or pebble beaches, sand bars, spits, sandy islets
6 Estuarine waters; includes permanent waters of estuaries and estuarine systems of deltas
7 Intertidal mud, sand or salt flats
8 Intertidal marshes; includes salt marshes, salt meadows, raised salt marshes, tidal brackish and freshwater marshes
9 Intertidal forested wetlands; includes mangrove swamps, nipa swamps, tidal freshwater swamp forests
10 Brackish to saline lagoons and marshes with one or more relatively narrow connections with the sea
11 Freshwater lagoons and marshes in the coastal zone
12 Non-tidal freshwater forested wetlands
B – Inland wetlands
13 Permanent rivers and streams; includes waterfalls
14 Seasonal and irregular rivers and streams
15 Inland deltas (permanent)
16 Riverine floodplains; includes seasonally flooded grassland, savanna and palm savanna; river flats; flooded river basins
17 Permanent freshwater lakes (>8 ha); includes large oxbow lakes
18 Seasonal/intermittent freshwater lakes (>8 ha), floodplain lakes
19 Permanent saline/brackish lakes
20 Seasonal/intermittent saline lakes
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 107 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
108
21 Permanent freshwater ponds (<8 ha), marshes and swamps on inorganic soils; emergent vegetation is waterlogged for at least most of the growing season
22 Seasonal/intermittent freshwater ponds and marshes on inorganic soils; includes billabongs, sloughs, potholes, seasonally flooded meadows, sedge marshes
23 Permanent saline/brackish marshes
24 Seasonal saline marshes
25 Shrub swamps; includes shrub-dominated freshwater marsh, shrub carr, alder thicket on inorganic soils
26 Freshwater swamp forest – seasonally flooded forest or wooded swamps on inorganic soils
27 Peatlands; includes forest, shrub or open bogs
28 Alpine and tundra wetlands; includes alpine meadows, tundra pools, temporary waters from snow melt
29 Freshwater springs, oases and rock pools
30 Geothermal wetlands
31 Inland subterranean karst wetlands
C – Human-made wetlands
32 Water storage areas; includes reservoirs, barrages, hydroelectric dams, impoundments (generally >8 ha)
33 Ponds; includes farm and stock ponds, small tanks (generally <8 ha)
34 Aquaculture ponds; includes fish ponds, shrimp ponds
35 Salt exploitation; includes salt pans, salines
36 Excavations; includes gravel pits, borrow pits, mining pools
37 Wastewater treatment, sewage farms, settling ponds, oxidation basins
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 108 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
109
38 Irrigated land and irrigation channels; includes rice fields, canals, ditches
39 Seasonally flooded arable land, farm land
40 Canals
RAINFORESTIn Australia, there are patches of rainforest across the tropical north, down the east coast, and in Tasmania. They are usually easy to distinguish from adjacent forests, which are typically dominated by Eucalyptus and related genera. Rainforests tend to have closed canopies that are usually dark green and easily distinguished from the generally greyish and reddish-green canopies of surrounding forests. The ‘dry scrubs’ of south-east Queensland are closely related to rainforests and are classified as such.
The ‘dry’ rainforests in the Northern Territory, Western Australia and parts of Queensland, as well as the temperate rainforests in south-eastern mainland Australia, are usually classified using the standard methods (see ‘Overview of the classification’, page 75). Due to their structural complexity, however, it may not be practical to classify the wet tropical and subtropical rainforests of Australia using the attributes and methods used for other vegetation types. The cool temperate rainforests of Tasmania can also be complex in structure. These two varieties of rainforests may be sampled using either the standard classification, or methods supplemented with extra structural attributes to fully reflect the additional complexity (Table 23). The rest of this section deals separately with these two special cases.
Tropical and subtropical rainforestsAustralian tropical rainforests are situated above 18° latitude whereas subtropical rainforests are between about 18° and 33° latitudes.
ComplexityTropical and subtropical rainforests of eastern Australia are classified as simple, simple–complex or complex depending on their structural complexity.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 109 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
110
S Simple Forests showing most or all of the following properties:the tendency for one or a few species to dominate the canopy (e.g. coachwood or myrtle beech)a reduced number of structural features (e.g. plant buttresses absent, or most stems unbuttressed or with star buttresses)a tendency for one or two growth forms to be more conspicuous (e.g. trunks not usually obscured by climbing plants and epiphytes, but when they do one growth form usually dominates; or understorey layers may have a conspicuous growth form such as a tree fern layer, ground fern layer, shrub or palm layer)the stem diameters of the canopy trees are usually uniform in sizediscrete strata (e.g. a tree fern layer, an understorey tree layer or shrubs).
X Simple–complex
Forests with features of simple and complex forests. Use this category if in doubt or if the vegetation does not possess at least four out of the five properties listed for the other categories.
Table 23 Additional attributes used to classify two special cases of rainforest
Wet tropical or subtropical rainforest Tasmanian cool temperate rainforest
For dominant stratum only, record:1. Complexity2. Leaf size3. Species4. Indicator growth form5. Crown cover (crown separation) and
height6. Emergents (if any)7. Sclerophyll species present
Identify dominant stratum and any other strata present.
For at least the dominant stratum and understorey strata, record:1. Dominant species2. Type of crown3. Height4. Species present (at least the dominants)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 110 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
111
C Complex Forests characteristically showing all or most of the following properties:
the tallest stratum, excluding emergent, has many speciesa large range of structural features (e.g. plant buttresses, spur buttresses, unbuttressed stems, compound leaves, simple leaves, lobed and deeply divided leaves, strap-like leaves)a large range of growth forms, none of which tends to dominate (e.g. trunk bases usually obscured by climbing pandans, palms, ferns and aroids; robust and slender lianes are present; complex understorey consisting of shrubs, seedlings of larger trees, palms, gingers, pandans and ferns)the vegetation is not usually arranged into distinguishable, discrete stratathe stem diameters of the tallest non-emergent trees are usually uneven in size.
Leaf sizeLeaf size classes for classifying wet tropical and subtropical rainforests are based on the sizes of the leaves of the tallest stratum trees. Precise calculation of leaf area is not required.
Record the length and width of a representative sample of canopy leaves (leaves that are exposed to the full sun during their early development, as occurs at the top of the canopy). Numerical values and a field sheet of actual leaf sizes are given in Figure 9; precision greater than the classes shown is not required.
The forest is described using one of nine terms depending on the proportion of individual trees in the tallest stratum with leaves in each of the leaf size categories (Table 24). Leaf size is assessed by examining leaves from 10 adjacent canopy trees in the sample plot. The following rules should be used:
Where the average leaf size of a tree appears to be intermediate between size classes (e.g. the leaf length of a lanceolate leaf is about 75 mm), the larger size class should be nominated.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 111 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
MacrophyllMesophyllNotophyllMicrophyllNanophyll
Leaf sizecategory
>182254500−182252025−4500225−202525−225
Leaf area(mm2)
>250125−25075−12525−75
<25
Approx. lengthof lanceolate leaf (mm)
>16080−16060−8020−60
<20
Approx. length ofcordate or peltate leaf (mm)
10
0
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
110
120
130
140
150mm
less thana Nanophyll
between 2x dand 8x thesize of therectangleMacrophyll
between c and 2dd Mesophyll
less thanc Notophyll
less thanb Microphyll
Figure 9 Actual leaf size categories for rainforest trees. From Walker and Hopkins (1990) based on Raunkiaer (1934) and Webb (1959).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 112 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
113
Only leaves that are exposed to the sun should be considered. Because these leaves are usually at the top of a tree, a shotgun or catapult may be necessary. An alternative is to locate recently fallen leaves on the ground.Leaves of palms, aroids and vines should not be considered.The size of the leaflet of a compound leaf should be considered.
Two possible, but unlikely, combinations of leaf sizes cannot be described adequately by this scheme. If all leaf sizes are represented equally (20% each), the forest should be described as notophyll. If any three size classes are represented equally (e.g. 30% macrophyll, 30% mesophyll and 30% notophyll), the intermediate leaf size term mesophyll should be selected.
SpeciesThe type of rainforest is named after the most abundant species of the dominant stratum, using the following system.
M Mixed No one or two species combined make 50% or more of the crown cover in the tallest stratum.
Table 24 Terms for describing leaf size in the tallest stratum of tropical or subtropical rainforest
Term describing leaf size of forest stand
Number of individual trees (maximum 10) with specified leaf sizes
Percentage of individuals in tallest stratum with specified leaf size
1 Macrophyll >5 macro >50% macro
2 Macrophyll–mesophyll 3–5 macro and 1–4 meso 30–50% macro and 10–40% meso
3 Mesophyll >5 meso >50% meso
4 Mesophyll–notophyll 3–5 meso and 1–4 noto 30–50% meso and 10–40% noto
5 Notophyll >5 noto >50% noto
6 Notophyll–microphyll 3–5 noto and 1–4 micro 30–50% noto and 10–40% micro
7 Microphyll >5 micro >50% micro
8 Microphyll–nanophyll 3–5 micro and 1–4 nano 30–50% micro and 10–40% nano
9 Nanophyll >5 nano >50% nano
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 113 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
114
S One or two The one or two species described constitute 50% species or more of the crown cover of the tallest stratum. description Common, generic or specific names can be used
(e.g. coachwood–crabapple; Ceratopetalum–Schizomeria; Ceratopetalum apetalum–Schizomeria ovata). Use species name abbreviations for coding (e.g. CEAPE.SCOVA) except for fan or feather palms, which should not be used as common names because they are used to denote structural features (see ‘Indicator growth forms’). Include sclerophyll species if they constitute 50% or more of the crown cover of the tallest stratum.
X Mixed Although no species or two species combined plus one make up 50% of the crown cover of the dominant species stratum, one species (the one species nominated)
is conspicuously abundant. As above, common, generic or specific names can be used except for feather or fan palms (e.g. Mixed Booyong; Mixed Argyrodendron; Mixed Argyrodendron trifoliolatum or ARTRI). This floristic term can be used to nominate species of particular indicator value to the user.
Many rainforest species occur in clusters of five or six trees. Care should be taken to ensure that the species of the tallest stratum are found over a much wider area than a few trees if the species qualifications are used.
Indicator growth formsMany of the simple rainforests and some of the complex and simple–complex rainforests develop strata dominated by particular growth forms. These growth forms are illustrated in Webb et al. (1976). Record the growth form name or code as follows.
1 Moss Forests in which mosses and lichens almost completely replace vascular epiphytes and vines on the trunks and in the crowns.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 114 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
115
2 Fern Tree ferns form a dense/closed (80–100% crown cover) and discrete understorey stratum.
3 Fan palm Forests in which fan palms (palms with branches spreading out in a fan shape, e.g. Licuala or Livistona) form a dense/closed stratum (80–100% crown cover) below the tallest stratum. If they form a closed stratum within the upper stratum, it would be registered as the third example in the section ‘Coding tropical or subtropical rainforests’.
4 Feather Forests in which feather palms (palms, e.g. coconut palm palms, with narrow long leaves that appear
feather-like from a distance) form a dense/closed (80–100% crown cover) understorey stratum.
5 Vine Forests in which vines or twining or scrambling plants drape at least 60% of the tallest stratum and emergent trees.
6 None If none of the five growth forms above reaches the required level of dominance nominated, the description should record ‘no dominant indicator growth form’.
These terms are inserted before or within the structural formation class: for example, ‘tall sparse fern forest’; ‘very tall closed fan palm forest’; ‘low closed vine shrubland’; ‘tall closed feather palm forest’.
Crown cover and heightCover and height classes have been defined previously (see Tables 17 and 20).
EmergentsEmergents are plants, usually trees, that are clearly above the dominant stratum and whose crown cover is less than 5% of the total crown cover (see ‘Emergents’, page 94). Trees that have a greater crown cover and project above a rainforest are coded and named using the standard classification (see Tables 17, 20 and 21).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 115 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
116
Record the genus and, if possible, species of emergents followed by the word ‘emergents’. For example: ‘with hoop pine emergents’; ‘with Araucaria emergents’; ‘with Eucalyptus emergents’. If no emergents are present, no qualifying character is nominated.
E Common sclerophyllous emergents over rainforest include species of Eucalyptus, Corymbia, Acacia, Syncarpia, Casuarina, Lophostemon and Melaleuca.
A Common non-sclerophyllous rainforest emergents include Agathis, Podocarpus, Araucaria, Flindersia and Erythrina.
Emergents are usually identified visually by experienced workers, but are confirmed by actual records of cover.
The crown cover of emergents may exceed 5% of the total crown cover in some instances. For example, in some forest stands Araucaria trees emerge above a closed rainforest canopy with their crown cover exceeding 5% of the total crown cover in some places. These patches should not be classified as separate vegetation types.
Sclerophyll species in dominant stratumRecord the presence of any sclerophyll genera. Common sclerophyll genera are Eucalyptus, Corymbia, Acacia, Syncarpia, Casuarina, Allocasuarina, Lophostemon, Tristaniopsis and Melaleuca. In this rainforest schema, Agathis, Podocarpus and Araucaria are not classed as sclerophyll.
S If sclerophyll species (defined above) are present in the dominant stratum, these should be recorded by adding the qualifying term ‘and sclerophylls’. If the sclerophylls can be identified, ‘sclerophyll’ should be replaced by the specific, generic or common name (e.g. ‘and wattles’). Where sclerophyll species are 50% of the crown cover of the canopy, this will have been recorded and need not be repeated.
Coding tropical/subtropical rainforestsTable 25 summarises codes for the tropical/subtropical rainforest classification. Examples are shown in Table 26.
Tasmanian rainforestsTasmanian rainforests can be sampled using the standard classification in the previous chapters of these guidelines. However, a method widely in use
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 116 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
117
Tabl
e 25
Attr
ibut
es a
nd c
odes
use
d to
cla
ssify
trop
ical
or
subt
ropi
cal r
ainf
ores
ts
Cor
e at
trib
utes
Qua
lifyi
ng a
ttri
bute
s
Com
plex
ity
Leaf
siz
e of
tre
es in
do
min
ant
stra
tum
Spec
ies
of t
rees
in
dom
inan
t st
ratu
m
Indi
cato
r gr
owth
fo
rm
Cro
wn
cove
r an
d he
ight
Em
erge
nts
Scle
roph
yll s
peci
es
in d
omin
ant
stra
tum
S S
impl
e
X
Sim
ple–
com
plex
C C
ompl
ex
1 M
acro
phyl
l
2 Mac
roph
yll–
mes
ophy
ll
3 M
esop
hyll
4
Mes
ophy
ll–no
toph
yll
5 N
otop
hyll
6 Not
ophy
ll–m
icro
phyl
l
7 M
icro
phyl
l
8 Mic
roph
yll–
nano
phyl
l
9 N
anop
hyll
M M
ixed
S D
escr
ibed
by
one
or tw
o sp
ecie
s
X M
ixed
plu
s on
e sp
ecie
s de
scri
ptio
n
1 M
oss
2 Fe
rn
3 Fa
n pa
lm
4 Fe
athe
r pa
lm
5 V
ine
6 N
one
See
Tabl
es
17 a
nd 2
0W
ith (s
peci
es
nam
e) e
mer
gent
E o
r A
E S
cler
ophy
ll em
erge
nts
A N
on-s
cler
ophy
ll em
erge
nts
With
(or
‘and
’) sc
lero
phyl
ls (o
r sp
ecie
s na
me)
S
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 117 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
118
Table 26 Examples to illustrate coding for both the standard and tropical or subtropical rainforest classification
Tropical/subtropical rainforest classificationStandard classificationa
Description Code Notes Code (Level 2)
Complex mesophyll mixed tall closed forest
C3M6 7Dw1.1
Simple notophyll very tall closed coachwood forest with Lophostemon confertus emergents
S5S6 E for emergents is coded with structure
E8w1.1 /8Dw1.1
Simple notophyll tall closed mixed fan palm forest and Acacia
S5M3S The last S is for sclerophylls in upper stratum
7Dw1.1
Simple notophyll tall closed Schizomeria forest with Syncarpia emergents and eucalypts
S5S6S The last S is for sclerophylls in upper stratum
E7w1.1 /7Dw1.1
Complex mesophyll mixed extremely tall closed black-bean forest
C3M6 9Dw1.1
Simple macrophyll–mesophyll low closed Macaranga–Trichospermum forest with Acacia emergents (young secondary forest)
S2S6S The last S is for sclerophylls in upper stratum
E5w1.1 /5Dw1.1
Mixture of Eucalyptus regnans giant very sparse trees above a simple microphyll very tall closed Atherosperma moschatum forest
S7S6 10Vw1.1 /8Dw1.1
a This is the standard classification as summarised in ‘Examples of standard classification’ (page 102) and Figure 8. Rainforests may be classified using either this standard classification alone, or using the more specialised tropical/subtropical rainforest classification shown in the first three columns of this table.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 118 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
119
Tabl
e 27
Dis
tingu
ishi
ng c
hara
cter
istic
s of
Tas
man
ian
rain
fore
sts
Tasm
ania
n ra
info
rest
cla
ssif
icat
ion
Stan
dard
cl
assi
fica
tion
a
Alli
ance
Cod
eSu
balli
ance
Des
crip
tion
Cod
e (L
evel
2)
Myr
tle
beec
hC
Cal
liden
drou
sM
ediu
m to
tall
fore
st d
omin
ated
by
Not
hofa
gus
cunn
ingh
amii
and
/or
Ath
eros
perm
a m
osch
atum
. Tre
es w
ell f
orm
ed a
nd w
idel
y sp
aced
; un
ders
tore
y op
en, s
hady
and
par
k-lik
e. L
ow d
iver
sity
of w
oody
sp
ecie
s, w
hich
are
spa
rse
and
inco
nspi
cuou
s in
the
unde
rsto
rey
of
mos
t com
mun
ities
.
6–7
Dw
1.1
Myr
tle
beec
hT
Tham
nic
Med
ium
hei
ght f
ores
t dom
inat
ed b
y tw
o to
five
spe
cies
, mos
tly o
f: N
otho
fagu
s cu
nnin
gham
ii, N
. gun
nii (
rare
ly),
Eucr
yphi
a lu
cida
, E.
mill
igan
ii, A
ther
ospe
rma
mos
chat
um, P
hyllo
clad
us a
spel
niifo
lius,
La
gero
stro
bus
fran
klin
ii an
d A
thro
taxi
s se
lagi
noid
es. T
rees
wel
l fo
rmed
; a d
istin
ct s
hrub
laye
r pr
esen
t.
6Mw
1.1
/5M
w3.
0
Myr
tle
beec
hI
Impl
icat
eLo
w fo
rest
, with
bro
ken
unev
en c
anop
ies.
Dom
inan
ce is
usu
ally
sh
ared
by
seve
ral s
peci
es in
clud
ing
Not
hofa
gus
cunn
ingh
amii,
N
. gun
nii (
rare
ly),
Eucr
yphi
a lu
cida
, E. m
illig
anii,
Phy
llocl
adus
as
peln
iifol
ius,
Ath
rota
xis
sela
gino
ides
, Lag
eros
trob
us fr
ankl
inii,
D
isel
ma
arch
eri,
Lept
ospe
rmum
niti
dum
, L. g
lauc
esce
ns, L
. sc
opar
ium
, L. l
anig
erum
, Mel
aleu
ca s
quar
rosa
and
Aca
cia
muc
rona
ta.
The
unde
rsto
rey
is ta
ngle
d an
d m
ostly
form
s a
cont
inuo
us la
yer
from
th
e gr
ound
to th
e ca
nopy
; em
erge
nts
may
be
pres
ent.
Spec
ies
dive
rsity
is r
elat
ivel
y hi
gh fo
r tr
ees
and
shru
bs.
(E) /
5Mw
1.1
/4S
w3.
0
Mon
tane
M
Low
fore
sts
dom
inat
ed b
y A
thro
taxi
s cu
pres
soid
es a
nd le
ss
com
mon
ly b
y A
. sel
agin
oide
s. T
he c
anop
y is
usu
ally
ope
n w
ith
wid
ely
spac
ed tr
ees,
thou
gh d
ense
clu
mps
may
occ
ur. T
he
unde
rsto
rey
is d
omin
ated
by
low
shr
ubs,
gra
sses
or
mos
ses
(Sph
agnu
m).
Shru
b he
ight
s ra
nge
from
hal
f to
two-
thir
ds th
e he
ight
of
the
cano
py. W
oody
spe
cies
div
ersi
ty is
rel
ativ
ely
high
.
5Sw
1.1
/4M
w3.
0 /0
Dm
1.0
a Th
is is
the
stan
dard
cla
ssifi
catio
n as
sum
mar
ised
in ‘E
xam
ples
of s
tand
ard
clas
sific
atio
n’ (p
age
102)
and
Fig
ure
8. R
ainf
ores
ts m
ay b
e cl
assi
fied
usin
g ei
ther
this
sta
ndar
d cl
assi
ficat
ion
alon
e, o
r us
ing
the
mor
e sp
ecia
lised
Tas
man
ian
rain
fore
st c
lass
ifica
tion
show
n in
the
first
four
col
umns
of t
his
tabl
e.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 119 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
120
in Tasmania classifies rainforest based on the work of Jarman et al. (1991) and Reid et al. (1999). This system uses a combination of floristics and structure that can be coded into the NVIS vegetation hierarchy at Level IV (Table 16).
The system divides Tasmanian rainforests into two alliances: myrtle beech and montane forest. Myrtle beech is the most widespread and, although recognised as comprising a continuum, it is divided into three suballiances: callidendrous, thamnic and implicate. The characteristics of these four units are presented in Table 27.
GROWTH STAGEThe growth stage of vegetation is its phase in the life cycle. Accurately assessing growth stage can be difficult in unfamiliar vegetation. Growth stage is better known for trees, and less well-known for vegetation dominated by non-woody plants.
Vegetation appearance can be affected by condition (see ‘Condition’) as well as growth stage. It may not be possible to distinguish the effects of age from responses due to stress caused by environmental factors such as pests, diseases or land use.
Walk through the site and immediate surrounding area, looking for signs that indicate the history of the development of the vegetation. Record the code from Table 28 as well as the features on which the assessed stage is based.
Where the vegetation is dominated by trees, especially eucalypts in south-eastern and south-western parts of Australia, the signs of ageing are evident and well documented (Jacobs 1955; Eyre et al. 2002; Figure 10a). Growth stages of trees in sparse vegetation (‘woodland’ trees) are similar to those in mid-dense and closed vegetation (‘forest’ trees), but the overall tree-form is shorter and wider (Figure 10b). There is little documentation of growth stages for shrubs. Lange and Purdie (1976) indicate the general cycle of ageing of western myall (Acacia papyrocarpa) shrubs in inland Australia, which can be used as guide for other shrubs (Figure 10c).
CONDITIONCondition refers to the state of vegetation relative to some specified benchmark. A benchmark is a set of attributes with values determined from either a single
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 120 4/02/09 12:05:26 PM
Vegetation
121
or a number of reference sites that represent the variability of the vegetation type (Thackway et al. 2006). The reference sites should be located precisely and their benchmark values recorded at known times.
A single site may be assessed from more than one perspective, depending on the focus of the condition assessment (Table 29). For example:
a ‘native vegetation integrity’ perspective would interest a biodiversity manager and should be compared to ‘fully natural’ benchmarksa ‘fodder production’ perspective would interest a grazing property manager and should be compared to ‘best-practice sustainable production’ benchmarksa ‘carbon sequestration’ perspective would interest a climate-change mitigation manager and should be compared to ‘optimum sustainable carbon capture or storage’ benchmarks.
Vegetation that is native, non-native or at different growth stages should each have its own benchmark. For native vegetation, the benchmarks should be based on the best examples representing pre-European conditions (sometimes called ‘fully natural’). For vegetation managed for economic production, benchmarks should be based on reference sites with best-practice, fully ecologically sustainable conditions.
Determine whether a benchmark exists for the vegetation being sampled, or whether published descriptions of the attributes of such sites exist.
Record the benchmark for the sample site.Vegetation Assets States and Transitions (VAST) may offer an approach for
translating, classifying and reporting the condition scores or states of vegetation at a range of scales. It is a classification approach that identifies a minimum of six states relative to the level of ‘modification’ and management of vegetation in the landscape (Thackway and Lesslie 2006). The diagnostic attributes for VAST include floristics, structure and regenerative capacity.
For assessing site-based remnant vegetation, particularly for biodiversity condition in native forest in south-eastern Australia, the attributes in Parkes et al. (2003) may be suitable.
Although the biodiversity condition of rangelands has received considerable research attention, final recommendations for assessing condition are not yet available (Smyth et al. 2003). Eyre et al. (2006) are using similar attributes to Parkes et al. (2003) and applying them to all vegetation in Queensland for biodiversity condition. Rangeland condition with respect to pastoral production
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 121 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
122
Tabl
e 28
Ind
icat
ors
of g
row
th s
tage
Cod
eG
row
th s
tage
Tree
s do
min
ant
Shru
bs d
omin
ant
Gra
sses
and
her
bs
dom
inan
tC
rypt
ogam
s do
min
ant
(mos
ses
and
liche
ns)
1Ea
rly
rege
nera
tion
Dom
inat
ed b
y sm
all,
juve
nile
, den
se to
ver
y sp
arse
reg
ener
atin
g pl
ants
, w
ith o
r w
ithou
t a fe
w
olde
r, w
idel
y sp
aced
, em
erge
nt p
lant
s.
Dom
inat
ed b
y sm
all,
juve
nile
, den
se to
ver
y sp
arse
reg
ener
atin
g pl
ants
. A fe
w o
lder
, w
idel
y sp
aced
em
erge
nts
may
be
pres
ent.
Plan
ts s
mal
l and
ju
veni
le s
tage
s pr
edom
inat
e; b
are
soil
or o
ld li
tter
com
mon
.
Thin
gro
wth
of y
oung
pl
ants
or
wid
ely
spac
ed c
lum
ps o
f yo
ung
plan
ts.
2A
dvan
ced
rege
nera
tion
Dom
inat
ed b
y de
nse
to
spar
se, w
ell-
deve
lope
d,
imm
atur
e pl
ants
. Lar
ge
emer
gent
s ca
n be
pre
sent
w
ith c
row
n co
ver
<5%
of
the
tota
l cro
wn
cove
r. H
owev
er, i
f the
cov
er is
>
5%, c
lass
ify a
s ‘u
neve
n ag
e’. T
rees
hav
e w
ell-
deve
lope
d st
ems
(pol
es).
Cro
wns
hav
e sm
all
bran
ches
. The
hei
ght i
s be
low
max
imum
hei
ght f
or
the
stan
d ty
pe. A
pica
l do
min
ance
stil
l app
aren
t in
vigo
rous
tree
s.
Dom
inat
ed b
y de
nse
to
spar
se, w
ell-
deve
lope
d bu
t not
mat
ure
plan
ts.
If la
rge
emer
gent
pla
nts
are
pres
ent,
then
they
oc
cupy
<5%
cro
wn
cove
r of
the
dom
inan
t st
ratu
m; i
f >5%
, cl
assi
fy a
s ‘u
neve
n ag
e’.
Veg
etat
ive
grow
th
abun
dant
; pla
nts
appr
oach
ing
full
mat
ure
size
but
re
prod
uctiv
e m
ater
ial
abse
nt o
r in
ear
ly
stag
es o
nly;
soi
l sur
face
la
rgel
y ob
scur
ed in
av
erag
e si
tes.
Cov
er o
f pla
nts
high
for
the
site
; som
e re
prod
uctio
n m
ay b
e ev
iden
t.
3U
neve
n ag
eM
ixed
siz
e an
d ag
e cl
asse
s,
usua
lly id
entif
ied
by tw
o or
mor
e st
rata
dom
inat
ed
by th
e sa
me
spec
ies,
but
ca
n al
so b
e si
tes
with
di
ffere
nt s
peci
es
rege
nera
ting
in th
e un
ders
tore
y of
an
olde
r ca
nopy
.
Mix
ed s
ize
and
age
clas
ses;
usu
ally
two
or
mor
e st
rata
dom
inat
ed
by th
e sa
me
spec
ies,
bu
t inc
lude
s si
tes
with
di
ffere
nt s
peci
es
rege
nera
ting
in th
e un
ders
tore
y of
an
olde
r ca
nopy
.
A m
ixtu
re o
f mat
ure,
pe
renn
ial a
nd
imm
atur
e an
nual
sp
ecie
s pr
esen
t on
site
.
A m
ixtu
re o
f mat
ure
repr
oduc
tive
plan
ts
with
imm
atur
e re
gene
ratio
n.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 122 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Vegetation
123
Cod
eG
row
th s
tage
Tree
s do
min
ant
Shru
bs d
omin
ant
Gra
sses
and
her
bs
dom
inan
tC
rypt
ogam
s do
min
ant
(mos
ses
and
liche
ns)
4M
atur
e ph
ase
Wel
l-sp
aced
mat
ure-
size
d pl
ants
or
dens
ely
pack
ed
plan
ts w
ith c
row
ns
touc
hing
, with
or
with
out
emer
gent
sen
esce
nt p
lant
s.
Tree
s at
max
imum
hei
ght
for
the
type
and
co
nditi
ons.
Cro
wn
at fu
ll la
tera
l dev
elop
men
t in
unlo
cked
sta
nds.
No
apic
al
dom
inan
ce.
May
hav
e w
ell-
spac
ed
mat
ure-
size
d pl
ants
, or
have
ver
y de
nsel
y pa
cked
pla
nts
with
cr
owns
touc
hing
, with
or
with
out e
mer
gent
se
nesc
ent p
lant
s.
Mos
t pla
nts
of
repr
oduc
tive
age;
de
pend
ing
on
vege
tatio
n ty
pe,
repr
oduc
tion
evid
ent,
or w
ould
be
if en
viro
nmen
tal
cond
ition
s w
ere
appr
opria
te (e
.g. w
ater
av
aila
bilit
y).
Swar
ds o
f pla
nts
com
mon
; pla
nts
of
mat
ure
phys
iogn
omy
(clu
mp
size
s an
d fo
rms)
; rep
rodu
ctio
n co
mm
on a
t app
ropr
iate
tim
es o
f yea
r or
dr
ough
t/ra
in c
ycle
; ov
eral
l hea
lth a
nd
vigo
ur h
igh.
5Se
nesc
ent
phas
eD
omin
ated
by
over
mat
ure
plan
ts p
artic
ular
ly in
the
dom
inan
t str
atum
; ev
iden
ce o
f sen
esce
nce
in
man
y pl
ants
, som
e w
ithou
t ob
viou
s lin
ks to
di
stur
banc
e. T
ree
crow
ns
show
sig
ns o
f con
trac
ting:
de
ad b
ranc
hes
and
decr
ease
d cr
own
diam
eter
an
d le
af a
rea.
Dis
tort
ed
bran
ches
and
bur
ls m
ay b
e co
mm
on. D
ead
tree
s m
ay
be p
rese
nt.
Dom
inat
ed b
y ol
d pl
ants
(thi
ck s
tem
s an
d pr
imar
y br
anch
es,
crow
ns e
ither
ex
trem
ely
dens
e w
ith
muc
h de
ad w
ood
or
thin
and
ope
n if
spec
ies
shed
s de
ad
bran
ches
), pa
rtic
ular
ly
in th
e do
min
ant
stra
tum
. Man
y se
nesc
ent p
lant
s, s
ome
with
out o
bvio
us li
nks
to d
istu
rban
ce.
In la
rgel
y an
nual
ve
geta
tion,
re
prod
uctio
n is
co
mpl
ete
and
plan
ts
are
dyin
g or
mos
tly
dead
; in
pere
nnia
l ve
geta
tion,
pla
nts
have
lo
st v
igou
r, ar
e br
eaki
ng d
own;
larg
e ar
eas
of s
oil a
re
expo
sed.
Litt
er
accu
mul
atio
n m
ay b
e hi
gh.
Cle
ar e
vide
nce
of th
e de
gene
ratio
n of
pla
nts
or c
lum
ps; d
ead
olde
r pa
rts
of p
lant
s m
ay b
e co
nspi
cuou
s.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 123 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
124
(a) forests (Preston 1997)
(b) woodland
(c) shrubs (Lange and Purdie 1976)
2 4
1 2 4 5 5 5 5
5 5
1 1 2 2 4 5
1
Figure 10 Growth stages. The numbers underneath refer to growth stage categories in Table 28.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 124 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Vegetation
125
has been assessed for many decades with on-ground surveys (Holm et al. 1987).
If a benchmark is available, compare the sample site to the standard for each of the attributes identified for that type of condition (for example biodiversity, commercial production, water resource). Rank the site accordingly. Parkes et al. (2003 and 2004) describe how to deal with site and reference site variability; they also suggest methods for evaluating and scoring sites. McCarthy et al. (2003) provide suggestions for improvements.
If no benchmark is available, and the sample is native vegetation, provide a qualitative assessment using the attributes provided in Thackway and Lesslie (2005), where VAST I is the benchmark.
Table 29 Scoring vegetation using benchmarks This example scores three vegetation types based on two different benchmarks. The score in each cell has a
potential maximum of 100.
Type/useScore relative to pre-European benchmark
Score relative to sustainable production benchmark (grazing cattle)
Remnant native closed to mid-dense trees (forest)
90 20
Grazed sparse trees (woodland)
55 85
Wheat field 5 25
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 125 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 126 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
127
LAND SURFACER.C. McDonald, R.F. Isbell and J.G. Speight
This chapter is concerned mainly with surface phenomena affecting land use and soil development that have traditionally been noted at the point of soil observation. Most of the attributes for land surface that are described have implications regarding the use of land; some may also reflect significant processes occurring within the soil (e.g. microrelief). Some attributes (e.g. disturbance of site, erosion) may reflect the influence of present or past land use practice, but it is important that their status be recorded at a known time.
It may be difficult to provide a reasonable estimate of some other required attributes (e.g. likely inundation), but the field observer usually has the benefit of some local experience and is better placed to make such an estimate than a subsequent user of the data.
ASPECTGive as compass bearing to nearest 10 degrees. On level lands (less than 1% slope), aspect need not be recorded.
ELEVATIONMeans of evaluation of elevation
L Levelled from survey datum or estimated from contour plan (1:10 000 or larger scale)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 127 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
128
M Interpolated from contour map with contour interval of 20 m or less
A Determined by altimeter
E Estimate
Elevation valueGive in metres above sea level.
DRAINAGE HEIGHTThis is the height of the point of soil observation above the flat, depression or stream channel that forms the effective bottom of the toposequence (page 28).
Means of evaluation of drainage heightAs in the previous section ‘Elevation’.
Drainage height valueGive drainage height in metres.
DISTURBANCE OF SITEThese are broad categories of disturbance. Users may subdivide where considered necessary.
0 No effective disturbance; natural
1 No effective disturbance other than grazing by hoofed animals
2 Limited clearing (e.g. selective logging)
3 Extensive clearing (e.g. poisoning, ringbarking)
4 Complete clearing; pasture, native or improved, but never cultivated
5 Complete clearing; pasture, native or improved, cultivated at some stage
6 Cultivation; rainfed
7 Cultivation; irrigated, past or present
8 Highly disturbed (e.g. quarrying, road works, mining, landfill, urban)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 128 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Land Surface
129
MICRORELIEFMicrorelief refers to relief up to a few metres about the plane of the land surface. It includes gilgai, hummocky, biotic and other microrelief.
Give the type of microrelief within the site:
Z Zero or no microrelief
Gilgai microreliefGilgai is surface microrelief associated with soils containing shrink–swell clays. It does not include microrelief that apparently results from repeated freezing and thawing, solifluxion or faunal activity. Gilgai consist of mounds and depressions showing varying degrees of order, sometimes separated by a subplanar or slightly undulating surface.
In order of increasing dimensions, gilgai types are:
C Crabhole irregularly distributed, small depressions and mounds gilgai separated by a more or less continuous shelf. Vertical
interval usually less than 0.3 m. Horizontal interval usually 3–20 m, surface almost level.
N Normal irregularly distributed, small mounds and subcircular gilgai depressions varying in size and spacing. Vertical interval
usually less than 0.3 m, horizontal interval usually 3–10 m, surface almost level.
L Linear long, narrow, parallel, elongate mounds and broader gilgai elongate depressions more or less at right angles to the
contour. Usually in sloping lands. Vertical interval usually less than 0.3 m, horizontal interval usually 5–8 m.
A Lattice discontinuous, elongate mounds and/or elongate gilgai depressions more or less at right angles to the contour.
Usually in sloping lands, commonly between linear gilgai on lower slopes and plains.
M Melonhole irregularly distributed, large depressions, usually gilgai greater than 3 m in diameter or greatest dimension,
subcircular or irregular and varying from closely spaced
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 129 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
130
in a network of elongate mounds to isolated depressions set in an undulating shelf with occasional small mounds. Some depressions may also contain sinkholes of gilgai usually greater than 0.3 m; horizontal interval usually 5–6 m; surface almost level.
G Contour long, elongate depressions and parallel adjacent gilgai downslope mounds, which follow the contour. These
depression–mound associations are separated from each other by shelves 10–100 m wide. Depressions are up to 0.5 m deep and 30–50 m wide. Mounds are low, usually less than 0.5 m high, and often poorly defined (after Lawrie 1978).
Proportions of gilgai componentsGive the proportions of gilgai components within the site, thus:
A Equal mounds and depressions; no shelf present
B More mounds than depressions; no shelf present
C Fewer mounds than depressions; no shelf present
D Mound, shelf and depressions; shelf forms prominent part of gilgai
Hummocky microreliefHummocky microrelief is not thought to be associated with the shrink–swell process involved in gilgai microrelief.
D Debil-debil small hummocks rising above a planar surface. They vary from rounded, both planar and vertically, to flat-topped, relatively steep-sided and elongate. They are usually closely and regularly spaced, ranging from 0.06 m to 0.6 m in both vertical and horizontal dimensions. They are common in northern Australia on soils with impeded internal drainage and in areas of short seasonal ponding. Many observers consider them to be formed by biological activity.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 130 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Land Surface
131
W Swamp steep-sided hummocks rising above a flat surface. hummock Hummocks are frequently occupied by trees or shrubs
while the lower surface may be vegetation free or occupied by sedges or reeds. They are subject to prolonged seasonal flooding.
Biotic microreliefThis relief is caused by biotic agents (e.g. termite mounds, rabbit warrens, wombat burrows, pig wallows, constructed terraces, stump holes, vegetation mounds).
No subdivision of any of the types of biotic microrelief according to the specific agent or component of relief is given here. For example, vegetation mounds are mounds of soil material found at the base of plants such as Dillon bush (Nitraria billardieri) or spinifex (Triodia species). Users may subdivide types of biotic microrelief where considered necessary, such as specifying the particular species of vegetation involved in the case of vegetation mounds. For example, termite mounds would be coded TM.
Agent
N Animal
M Man
B Bird
T Termite
A Ant
V Vegetation
O Other
Component of relief
M Mound
E Elongate mound
D Depression
L Elongate depression
H Hole
T Terrace
O Other
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 131 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
132
Other microrelief
U Mound/ depression microrelief
undifferentiated, irregularly distributed or isolated mounds and/or depressions set in a planar surface.
K Karst microrelief depressions in limestone country.
I Sinkhole closed depression with vertical or funnel-shaped sides.
S Mass movement microrelief
hummocky microrelief on the surface of landslides, slumps, earth flows, debris avalanches.
R Terracettes small terraces on slopes resulting either from soil creep or trampling by hoofed animals.
T Contour trench trenches typically 0.2 m deep and 0.6 m wide, with near vertical walls, alternating with flat-crested ridges about 1.3 m wide, which extend along the contour for several metres or tens of metres. Contour trenches are known in areas in south-eastern Australia above 350 m altitude with a high effective rainfall, where they are associated with a grassland or heathland vegetation on undulating rises (compare with McElroy 1952).
P Spring mound Mound associated with water flowing from rock or soil without human intervention.
H Spring hollow Depression associated with water flowing from rock or soil without human intervention.
O Other microrelief
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 132 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Land Surface
133
Vertical intervalGive vertical distance, in metres, between base of depression or flat and horizontal line joining crests of mounds or hummocks.
Horizontal intervalGive horizontal distance, in metres, between crests of mounds or tops of hummocks.
Component of microrelief sampledGive the component of the microrelief in which the described soil profile is located.
M Mound convex; long axis8 not more than 3 times the shorter axis.
E Elongate mound convex; long axis8 more than 3 times the shorter axis.
D Depression concave; occurs as closed form.
L Elongate concave; occurs as open-ended form. depression
S Shelf more or less planar; occurs between mounds and depressions.
K Hummock rises above a flat or planar surface. Sides vary from rounded to near vertical and tops from rounded to flat.
F Flat surface in which hummocks, mounds, depressions or sinkholes are set.
EROSIONThis section is concerned with accelerated erosion rather than natural erosion. Natural or geologic erosion is the type and rate of movement of land surface material in its undisturbed natural environment. Accelerated erosion is the
8 Axis in the plane of the land surface.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 133 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
134
more rapid erosion that follows the destruction or loss of protective cover often resulting from people’s influence on the soil, vegetation or landform. It is not always easy to distinguish between accelerated and natural erosion in some landscapes where both are closely interrelated, nor is it always clear whether wind or water is the dominant agent. This is particularly so in the case of scald formation (Warren 1965).
The complexity of erosion forms creates difficulties in both defining and quantitatively estimating the extent of erosion within the dimensions of the site. Hence, the observer is advised to record the following simple parameters. Assess the erosion observed at the time of the description, not the likelihood of erosion.
For erosion, aggradation and inundation assessment, the extent of the site is 20 m radius.
State of erosion
A Active one or both of the following conditions apply: evidence of sediment movement; sides and/or floors of erosion form are relatively bare of vegetation.
S Stabilised one or both of the following conditions apply: no evidence of sediment movement; sides and/or floors of erosion form are revegetated.
P Partly stabilised evidence of some active erosion and some evidence of stabilisation.
Wind erosion WGive presence/absence or extent of accelerated erosion.
X Not apparent
0 No wind erosion
1 Minor or present some loss of surface.
2 Moderate most or all or surface removed leaving soft or loose material.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 134 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Land Surface
135
3 Severe most or all of surface removed, leaving hard material.
4 Very severe deeper layers exposed, leaving hard material (e.g. subsoil, weathered country rock or pans).
Scald erosion CThis is the removal of surface soil by water and/or wind, often exposing a more clayey subsoil which is devoid of vegetation and relatively impermeable to water. Scalds are most common in arid or semi-arid lands.
0 No scalding1 Minor scalding <5% of site scalded.2 Moderate scalding 5–50% of site scalded.3 Severe scalding >50% of site scalded.
Water erosionGive type and presence/absence or extent of accelerated erosion.
For sheet, rill and gully erosion there is no consensus in Australia on a quantitative or precise definition of what constitutes minor, moderate and severe erosion. This derives partly from the difficulty of measuring actual soil loss at a site. It also derives partly from the wide range of soils, climates and land uses, variations in any or all of which may alter the concept of minor, moderate or severe erosion.
The observer wishing to record the severity of erosion may record it as minor, moderate or severe, basing the assessment on local knowledge and guided by indicators that may be present as described below (after Morse et al. 1987). Note the actual depth of soil loss where this can be reliably assessed.
Sheet erosion SThis is the relatively uniform removal of soil from an area without the development of conspicuous channels.
Indicators of sheet erosion include soil deposits in downslope sediment traps, such as fencelines or farm dams, and pedestalling, root exposure or exposure of subsoils.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 135 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
136
X Not apparent
0 No sheet erosion
1 Minor indicators may include shallow soil deposits in downslope sediment traps (fencelines, farm dams). Often very difficult to assess as evidence may be lost with cultivation, pedoturbation or revegetation.
2 Moderate indicators may include partial exposure of roots, moderate soil deposits in downslope sediment traps (fencelines, farm dams).
3 Severe indicators may include loss of surface horizons, exposure of subsoil horizons, pedestalling, root exposure, substantial soil deposits in downslope sediment traps (fencelines, farm dams).
Rill erosion RA rill is a small channel up to 0.3 m deep, which can be largely obliterated by tillage operations (Houghton and Charman 1986).
0 No rill erosion1 Minor occasional rills.2 Moderate common rills.3 Severe numerous rills forming corrugated ground surface.
Gully erosion GA gully (see page 39) is a channel more than 0.3 m deep.
0 No gully erosion
1 Minor gullies are isolated, linear, discontinuous and restricted to primary or minor drainage lines.
2 Moderate gullies are linear, continuous and restricted to primary and minor drainage lines.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 136 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Land Surface
137
3 Severe gullies are continuous or discontinuous and either tend to branch away from primary drainage lines and on to footslopes, or have multiple branches within primary drainage lines.
Gully depthThis gives the maximum depth within the site.
1 <1.5 m
2 1.5–3.0 m
3 >3 m
Tunnel erosion TThis is the removal of subsoil by water while the surface soil remains relatively intact (Crouch 1976).
X Not apparent
0 No tunnel erosion
1 Present
Stream bank erosion BThis is the removal of soil from a stream bank, typically during periods of high stream flow.
X Not apparent
0 No stream bank erosion
1 Present
Wave erosion VErosion of beaches, beach ridges and/or dunes. This is the removal of sand or soil from the margins of beaches, beach ridges, dunes, lakes or dams by wave action.
X Not apparent
0 No wave erosion
1 Present
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 137 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
138
Mass movement MThis includes all relatively large downslope movement of soil, rock or mixture of both (e.g. landslides, slumps, earth flows, debris avalanches and solifluxion).
0 No mass movement
1 Present
AGGRADATIONThis refers to the presence of material deposited on a pre-existing surface as a result of wind and/or water erosion.
X Not apparent
0 No aggradation
1 Present
INUNDATIONInundation includes flooding from overbank flow, inundation from local runon and overland flow.
Although the importance of this information is considerable, in most instances it cannot be assessed at each site. Some evidence may be available from past events (e.g. accumulation of debris in trees or on fences). Otherwise information is usually obtained from local enquiry.
FrequencyGive long-term average of inundation. Among alluvial plains, flood plains typically fall in categories 4 and 3.
0 No inundation
1 Less than one occurrence per 100 years
2 One occurrence in between 50 and 100 years
3 One occurrence in between 10 and 50 years
4 One occurrence in between 1 and 10 years
5 More than one occurrence per year
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 138 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Land Surface
139
Duration (annual)Give likely duration of an inundation event.
1 Less than 1 day
2 Between 1 and 20 days
3 Between 20 and 120 days
4 More than 120 days
Depth (annual)Give likely maximum depth of water in an inundation event.
1 <50 mm
2 50–100 mm
3 100–300 mm
4 300–1000 mm
5 >1000 mm
Runon velocityAs a guide, the surface velocity in a river is typically 1–2 m/s.
L Low velocity <300 mm/s
H High velocity >300 mm/s
COARSE FRAGMENTSCoarse fragments are particles coarser than 2 mm. They include unattached rock fragments and other fragments such as charcoal and shells. Coarse fragments are distinguished from segregations of pedogenic origin (see page 195) in that they are not, or not considered to be, of pedogenic origin.
Both coarse fragments and segregations of pedogenic origin can occur on the surface. Where segregations of pedogenic origin occur on the surface, they should be described as on page 195.
Abundance of coarse fragmentsThe percentage is estimated by eye using the charts in Figure 11 for comparison.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 139 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
140
0 No coarse fragments 01 Very slightly or very few, for example very slightly fine gravelly; very few small pebbles <2%2 Slightly or few, for example slightly stony; few stones 2–10%3 No qualifier or common, for example medium gravelly; stony, common medium pebbles; common stones 10–20%4 Moderately or many 20–50%5 Very or abundant 50–90%6 Extremely or very abundant >90%
Size of coarse fragmentsThe scale adopted uses class boundaries at (2 × 10n/2) mm, where n is an integer. This system is an extension of that used for particles smaller than 2 mm both in the scheme of the British Standards Institution and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology (see Figure 15, page 162) and the original Atterberg (1905) scheme on which the International Scheme was based. It is thus compatible with both the International Scheme referred to in the field texture section (page 161) and the grain size criteria for substrate materials (page 206).
The terms used to describe size apply to fragments of any shape. The average maximum dimension of fragments is used to determine the class interval.
1 Fine gravelly9 or small pebbles 2–6 mm2 Medium gravelly or medium pebbles 6–20 mm3 Coarse gravelly or large pebbles 20–60 mm4 Cobbly or cobbles 60–200 mm5 Stony or stones 200–600 mm6 Bouldery or boulders 600–2000 mm7 Large boulders >2000 mm
9 Note that in preparing soils for laboratory analysis, the greater than 2 mm size fraction is commonly recorded as ‘gravel’.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 140 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Land Surface
141
Figure 11 Chart for estimating abundance of coarse fragments (page 139), mottles (pages 159–60), and segregations of pedogenic origin (page 195). Each quarter of any one square has the same area of black.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 141 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
142
Shape of coarse fragmentsGive shape using Figure 12 as a visual guide.
A AngularS SubangularU SubroundedR RoundedAT Angular tabularST Subangular tabularUT Subrounded tabularRT Rounded tabularAP Angular platySP Subangular platyUP Subrounded platy
RP Rounded platy
Lithology of coarse fragments
M Same as substrate material (page 209)
R Same as rock outcrop (pages 143–4)
Where the lithology of coarse fragments is different from that of either the substrate material, the rock outcrop or both, describe it as for lithology of substrate material (see Table 35, page 214).
Some coarse fragments are commonly encountered that are not listed in any category above. These include:
IS Ironstone (where not considered of pedogenic origin)SS ShellsCC CharcoalPU PumiceOW Opalised woodOT Other
Strength of coarse fragmentsSame as for ‘Strength of material’ (see page 209).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 142 4/02/09 12:05:27 PM
Land Surface
143
ROCK OUTCROPThis refers to any exposed area of rock that is inferred to be continuous with underlying bedrock.
Abundance of rock outcrop
0 No rock outcrop no bedrock exposed.1 Very slightly rocky <2% bedrock exposed.2 Slightly rocky 2–10% bedrock exposed.
R R RT RP
R R RT RP
U U UT UP
S S ST SP
A A AT
Sphericity
Rou
ndne
ss
Subangular
Subrounded
Rounded
Angular
AP
PlatyTabular
Figure 12 Coarse fragment shape.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 143 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
144
3 Rocky 10–20% bedrock exposed.4 Very rocky 20–50% bedrock exposed.5 Rockland >50% bedrock exposed.
Lithological type of rock outcropWhere the lithology of the rock outcrop is different from that of the substrate material, record it as for lithology of substrate material (see page 214, Table 35).
DEPTH TO FREE WATERGive depth to free water at the site of soil observation, in metres, either above or below the soil surface, excluding litter and living vegetation. Prefix the depth above or below the soil surface as follows:
+ Above soil surface
– Below soil surface
If there is no free water, record:
0 No free water
RUNOFFRunoff is the relative rate at which water runs off the soil surface. It is largely determined by slope, surface cover and soil infiltration rate.
0 No runoff
1 Very slow free water on surface for long periods, or water enters soil immediately. Soils usually either level to nearly level or loose and porous.
2 Slow free water on surface for significant periods, or water enters soil relatively rapidly. Soils usually either nearly level to gently sloping or relatively porous.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 144 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Land Surface
145
3 Moderately rapid
free water on surface for short periods only; moderate proportion of water enters soil.
4 Rapid large proportion of water runs off; small proportion enters soil. Water runs off nearly as fast as it is added. Soils usually have moderate to steep slopes and low infiltration rates.
5 Very rapid very large proportion of water runs off; very small proportion enters soil. Water runs off as fast as it is added. Soils usually have steep to very steep slopes and low infiltration rates.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 145 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 146 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
147
SOIL PROFILER.C. McDonald and R.F. Isbell
A soil profile is a vertical section of a soil from the soil surface through all its horizons to parent material, other consolidated substrate material or selected depth in unconsolidated material.
A soil profile can be seen as an individual (Macvicar 1969, page 143; Northcote 1979, page 22) that is described by giving a single value to each property. This is distinct from the pedon (Soil Survey Staff 1975), a three-dimensional soil body that can only be described by a range of values for each property. Considering the variability inherent in soils, ideally a soil description would give a range of values for each property recorded in each of the three dimensions in each horizon. In practice this is not possible as the pedologist can describe factually only the very small parts of the soil body actually seen. Most soil descriptions are given with a single value for each property described and thus refer to soil profiles.
TYPE OF SOIL OBSERVATIONThe soil profile may be described from the following (listed in order of preference):
P Soil pitE Existing vertical exposureC Relatively undisturbed soil core
A Auger boring
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 147 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
148
To characterise a soil profile fully, it should be examined to the depth of the parent material or other consolidated material. However, because soil depth varies between very wide limits and because soils are examined for a wide variety of purposes, the depth of examination in practice frequently may not exceed 1.5–2 m.
HORIZONSA soil horizon is a layer of soil, approximately parallel to the land surface, with morphological properties different from layers below and/or above it. Tongues of material from one horizon may penetrate into adjacent horizons. Give horizon notation as described below.
As horizon notation is deduced from the profile description data (Northcote 1979) and in some instances laboratory data, record it after the profile is described. Horizons may be difficult to name, but should be named in the field. Opinions formed at the time of description are useful for later reference.
With regard to horizon notation, the long-established usage in horizon designation is adopted. Emphasis is on factual objective notation rather than assumed genesis, as genetic implications are often uncertain and difficult to establish. Thus the notation ‘E’ indicating eluvial horizon (International Society of Soil Science 1967) has not been used, even though this has been adopted by several organisations in other countries (e.g. Hodgson 1974; Soil Survey Staff 1990).
O horizonsThese are horizons dominated by organic materials in varying stages of decomposition that have accumulated on the mineral soil surface. They are usually divided into O1 and O2 horizons.
O1 horizon consists of undecomposed organic debris, usually dominated by leaves and twigs. The original form of the debris can be recognised with the naked eye.
O2 horizon consists of organic debris in various stages of decomposition. The original form of most of the debris cannot be recognised with the naked eye.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 148 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
149
P horizonsThese are horizons dominated by organic materials in various stages of decomposition that have accumulated either under water or in conditions of excessive wetness. They have long been known as peat. The organic material consists of the remains of plants that have been growing in place. They may be divided into P1 and P2 horizons as in O1 and O2 above.
When such horizons are buried, they may be designated in a manner similar to designations for buried mineral soils (page 156), for example 2P1, 3P2, etc.
P1 horizon consists primarily of undecomposed or weakly decomposed organic material (fibric peat). Plant remains are distinct and readily identifiable.
P2 horizon consists primarily of moderately to completely decomposed organic material (hemic to sapric peat). Plant remains vary from being difficult to identify to completely amorphous.
A horizonsThese are horizons either consisting of one or more surface mineral horizons with some organic accumulation and usually darker in colour than the underlying horizons, or consisting of surface and subsurface horizons that are lighter in colour but have a lower content of silicate clay and/or sesquioxides than the underlying horizons.
A1 horizon mineral horizon at or near the soil surface with some accumulation of humified organic matter, usually darker in colour than underlying horizons and with maximum biologic activity for any given soil profile. It may be divided into subhorizons and of these the A11 horizon is usually the more organic, or darker coloured uppermost portion. The A12 differs in either hue, value or chroma from the A11, usually being lighter in colour. It is not pale enough to qualify as an A2 horizon. The A1 may be further divided into subhorizons if necessary (e.g. A13, A14).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 149 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
150
A2 horizon mineral horizon having, either alone or in combination, less organic matter, sesquioxides, or silicate clay than immediately adjacent horizons. It is usually differentiated from the A1 horizon by its paler colour, that is, by having colour value at least one unit higher and usually less organic matter. It is usually differentiated from the B horizon by having colour value at least one unit higher and chroma at least two units lower, by coarser texture or by a combination of these attributes.
A3 horizon transitional horizon between A and B, which is dominated by properties characteristic of an overlying A1 or A2.
B horizonsThese are horizons consisting of one or more mineral soil layers characterised by one or more of the following: a concentration of silicate clay, iron, aluminium, organic material or several of these; a structure and/or consistence unlike that of the A horizons above or of any horizons immediately below; stronger colours, usually expressed as higher chroma and/or redder hue, than those of the A horizons above or those of the horizons below.
B1 horizon transitional horizon between A and B, which is dominated by properties characteristic of an underlying B2.
B2 horizon horizon in which the dominant feature is one or more of the following:
clay, or iron, aluminium or humus, either alone or in combination
10 as evidenced by a different structure and/or consistence, and/or stronger colours than the A horizons above or any horizon immediately below.
It may be divided into subhorizons (e.g. B21, B22, B23).
10 Pedologic organisation is a broad term used to include all changes in soil material resulting from the effect of physical, chemical and biologic processes, that is, soil formation. Results of these processes include horizontation, colour differences, presence of pedality, and texture and/or consistence changes.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 150 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
151
B3 horizon transitional horizon between B and C or other subsolum material in which properties characteristic of an overlying B2 dominate, but intergrade to those of the underlying material.
C horizonsThese are layers below the solum (AB profile) of consolidated or unconsolidated material, usually partially weathered, little affected by pedogenic processes, and either like or unlike the material from which the solum presumably formed. The C horizon lacks properties characteristic of O, P, A, B or D horizons. It is recognised by its lack of pedological development and/or the presence of geologic organisation frequently expressed as sedimentary laminae or as ghost rock structure as in saprolite. C horizons include consolidated rock and sediments that, when moist, can be dug with hand tools. Rock strength is generally weak or weaker. Because of their nature, C horizons may be described as detailed in this chapter or as substrate (see page 205).
D horizonsThese are considered here to be any soil material below the solum that is unlike the solum in its general character, is not C horizon, and cannot be given reliable horizon designation as described in ‘Lithologic discontinuities’ or ‘Buried soils’ (see page 156). Thus, a D horizon may be recognised by the contrast in pedologic organisation between it and the overlying horizons.
R horizonsThese horizons consist of continuous masses (not boulders) of moderately strong to very strong rock (excluding pans, page 192) such as bedrock. R horizons may have cracks but these are few enough and/or fine enough that few roots penetrate and there is no significant displacement of rock. It is usually too strong to dig with hand tools, even when moist.
Transitional horizonsTwo main kinds are distinguished:
transitional horizons that have subordinate properties of both horizons but are not dominated by properties characteristic of either horizon. For example, AB, AC, BC horizons.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 151 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
152
transitional horizons in which distinct parts have recognisable properties of two kinds of horizons indicated by capital letters (Soil Survey Staff 1990). The two capital letters are separated by a virgule (/) as A/B, A/C, B/C. Most of the individual parts of at least one of the components are surrounded by the other.
The first symbol is that of the horizon that makes up the greater volume.
Bleached horizonsSome horizons are white, near white or much paler than adjacent horizons. Bleached horizons most commonly occur as A2 horizons but are not restricted to them.
Bleached horizons are defined in terms of Munsell notations for dry soil:
for all hues, value 7 or greater with chroma 4 or lesswhere adjacent horizons have hues 5YR or redder, value 6 or greater with chroma 4 or less.
Two kinds of bleached horizons are recognised:Conspicuously bleached: 80% or more of the horizon is bleached.Sporadically bleached: bleach occurs:
irregularly through the horizonas blotches, often less than 6 mm thick, at the interface of horizons, most commonly A and B horizonsas nests of bleached grains of soil material at the interface of horizons, most commonly A and B horizons, when no other evidence of a bleached horizon may occur.
Cracking claysThe A and B horizons in cracking clays are defined and recognised on the basis of structure rather than colour (McDonald 1977).
The A horizon in cracking clays may be structured or massive. The structural A horizon is the granular, subangular blocky, angular blocky or polyhedral surface horizon where ped faces are not accommodated and have irregular coarse voids between them. This is exemplified in soils with a self-
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 152 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
153
mulching surface. The A horizon structure is unstable only in the sense that relatively rapid wetting and drying continually creates new peds and voids.
The B horizon is the coarse angular blocky and/or lenticular horizon where ped faces are all accommodated and usually have only narrow planar voids between them. The B horizon structure is stable because of relatively slow wetting and drying. The B horizon will usually occur within 200 mm of the surface, but the structural change must be confirmed using a spade or exposure to examine the soil. The boundary may often be gradual or diffuse, but can be clear or abrupt.
Horizon suffixes
b11 used for buried soil horizons. Used in mineral soils only. The suffix is written last (e.g. 2B2b).
c used for horizons with accumulation of concretions or nodules of iron and/or aluminium and/or manganese, as in B2c.
d used for densipans. Very fine, sandy, earthy pan (see page 194).
e used for conspicuously bleached horizons (e.g. A2e).
f used when faunal accumulation, such as worm casts, dominates certain A1 horizons (e.g. A1f in some soils under rainforest).
g indicates strong gleying, as in B2g. Gleying is indicative of permanent or periodic intense reduction due to wetness; it is characterised by greyish, bluish or greenish colours, generally of low chroma. Mottling may be prominent; mottles may have reddish hues and higher chromas if oxidising conditions occur periodically. Roots may have rusty or yellowish outlines; hence horizons such as A1g can occur.
h used where horizons contain accumulation of amorphous, organic matter–aluminium complexes in which iron contents are very low. The dominantly organic matter–aluminium complexes occur as discrete pellets between clean sand grains or completely fill the voids; occasionally they may coat sand grains. Such horizons may be soft or
11 This suffix should only be used according to the definition of buried soils on page 156.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 153 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
154
cemented and form the characteristic B horizon of poorly drained soils known as podzols or Podosols.
j used for sporadically bleached horizons (e.g. A2j).
k12 used for horizons with accumulation of carbonates, commonly calcium carbonate, as in B2k.
m used for horizons with strong cementation or induration. It is confined to irreversibly cemented horizons that are essentially continuous (>90%) though they may be fractured.
p used for horizons where ploughing, tillage practices or other disturbance by humans has occurred (e.g. deep ripping). This suffix is used only with A, as in Ap2. Where the plough layer clearly includes what was once B horizon and it is no longer possible to infer with any reliability what the texture and depth of the A horizon was, the plough layer is designated Ap. An Ap horizon may be subdivided into subhorizons (e.g. Ap1, Ap2). Note: An Ap2 horizon is not the same as an A2 horizon but a subdivision equivalent to A12.
q used for horizons with accumulation of secondary silica. If silica cementation is continuous or nearly continuous, ‘qm’ is used.
r used for horizons with layers of weathered rock (including saprolite) that, although consolidated, can be dug with hand tools.
s used for horizons with an accumulation of sesquioxide–organic matter complexes in which iron is dominant relative to aluminium. These complexes coat sand grains, occur as discrete pellets, or, with moderate amounts of iron, may fill voids forming cemented patches. The content of organic matter is variable and its distribution is often irregular. The suffix ‘s’ is often used in combination with ‘h’ (as in
12 These suffixes are usually recorded only if there is a common or larger abundance of these segregations (see page 195). Horizons with few (2–10%) or very few (<2%) segregations are not usually given these horizon notations. These suffixes indicate relative accumulations compared with other horizons. Thus, in a soil with no carbonate except for one horizon with few segregations, this horizon could be designated with a suffix ‘k’ (e.g. B22tk). However, in a soil with few segregations of carbonate throughout, no horizon would be given the suffix ‘k’ unless it had common or more segregations (i.e. a relatively larger amount than adjacent horizons).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 154 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
155
Bhs) where both organic and iron components are significant; s or Bhs horizons may be soft or hard and form the characteristic B horizon of free-draining podzols or Podosols.
t used for horizons with accumulation of silicate clay (from German ton, clay). Different mechanisms (e.g. illuviation, formation in situ) may be responsible for the clay accumulation, but these may be difficult to confirm. This suffix is used only with the B, for example B2t, to indicate the nature of the B.
w used where development of colour and/or structure, or both, in the B horizon is observed, with little or no accumulation of sesquioxide–organic matter complexes.
x used for fragipans or earthy pans. A horizon with high bulk density relative to the horizon above, seemingly cemented when dry, but showing a moderate to weak cementation when moist (see page 193).
y12 used for horizons with accumulation of calcium sulfate (gypsum), as in B21, B22.
z used for horizons with accumulation of salts more soluble than calcium sulfate and calcium carbonate.
? query. Used where doubt is associated with the nomenclature of the horizon, with the query following the horizon notation (e.g. ‘D?’).
Subdivision of horizonsAll horizon subdivisions are numbered consecutively from the top of each horizon downward, as in A11, A12, A2, B21, B22, B23. The numeric suffix always precedes the alphabetic suffix except with the alphabetic suffix ‘p’ where the number always follows the letter.
The above horizon nomenclature will cover most soils, but there will be instances where there are buried soils (pedologic discontinuities) (see Figure 14) and also where a profile has formed on what are obviously different parent materials (lithologic discontinuities) (Figure 13). Where there are buried soils and it is not possible to identify reliably the horizon as A or B, then these are D horizons (e.g. Profile E, Figure 13).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 155 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
156
Lithologic discontinuitiesWhere obvious contrasts in lithology exist between different horizons in the soil profile, or between the soil profile and the underlying lithology, the different lithologic layers are given a numeric prefix (Figure 13).
Each layer may consist of one or more horizons. The different layers are numbered from the top downward. The upper layer is not numbered 1, this being understood. Numbering starts with the second layer, which is designated 2. Even though a layer below material 3, for example, is similar to material 2, it is designated 4 in the sequence (see Profiles C and D in Figure 13). Discrimination of lithological discontinuities from soil horizon boundaries will depend in each case upon the degree of pedological organisation and the contrast between lithological units (e.g. see Profiles C and D in Figure 13).
Where lithologic discontinuities are suspected in the profile but there is no clear evidence, either the numeric prefix should not be used or a query should be added to indicate doubt. It is better used only where there is clear evidence. Whether the numeric prefix is used or not, the horizon naming, with appropriate suffixes, remains the same, as illustrated in Figure 13 examples.
Buried soilsWhere there are buried soils, and it is possible to designate reliably the horizon nomenclature in the buried profiles, the buried horizons are given the suffix ‘b’ which is written last. Number the different soils from the top downward. The upper soil, or modern soil, is not numbered 1, this being understood. Two examples are given in Figure 14.
DEPTH OF HORIZONSThe upper and lower depths, in metres, of each horizon are measured from the soil surface, excluding O horizons. O horizon depths are measured above the mineral soil surface (e.g. O1 0.12–0.10 m; O2 0.1–0.0 m).
A scaled horizon diagram may be useful where horizons are irregular.
DEPTH TO R HORIZON OR STRONGLY CEMENTED PANGive depth to R horizon or strongly cemented pan (see page 192) in metres.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 156 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
157
Figure 13 Lithologic discontinuities and soil horizon nomenclature.In Profile C, the degree of development of the B22 horizon overrides any lithologic
discontinuity between the B22 and 2B22 horizon; hence, no soil horizon boundary is shown between them.
In Profile D, lithologic characteristics allow recognition of separate sedimentary layers in the upper solum. The horizon boundary between the A11 and 2A12 is also recognised by the pedological differences within the A1 horizon. However, the gross characteristics of the A2 horizon (e.g. a conspicuous bleach) have developed in two different lithologies in layers 2A2 and 3A2.
In Profile E, layer 3D is equivalent to layer 5D in Profiles C and D.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 157 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
158
3A1b
2B2b
B21
B22
A3
A1
2A1b
2A2b
3Bb
3Cb
2Cb
Sedimentarylayer 1
Sedimentarylayer 2
Sedimentarylayer 3
Present land surface
Surface of buried soil
Surface of buried soil
ProfileA
ProfileB
2Db
B21
B22
A3
A1
3Db
Figure 14 Buried soils and soil horizon nomenclature.In Profile A, the buried soils have reliably identified horizons; in Profile B, they do not.
Buried soils will always be overlain by a sedimentary layer that is different from the material in which they occur. Therefore, lithologic discontinuities in the profile must be designated.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 158 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
159
The purpose of recording this depth is to include in the soil description those materials that may be relatively easily moved by earth-moving equipment or may be relatively easily penetrated by roots. Strong or very strong rock or pan that may require ripping or blasting to move, and/or has little or no root penetration, is excluded.
COLOURRecord colours by comparing soils with colour charts using the Munsell Color system, for example the Munsell Soil Color Charts or the Revised Standard Soil Color Charts (Oyama and Takehara 1970).
Hue, value and chroma of the matrix colour are recorded, for example 10YR4/2.
Soil colours rarely match the chart colour chips perfectly. They should be matched to the chip closest in colour, or the nearest whole number in chroma where chips are not provided (e.g. chromas 5 and 7).
The soil colour is measured on the surface of a freshly broken aggregate of moist soil. Moisten the soil if it is dry. Record the colour when the visible moisture film disappears from the surface of the moistened broken aggregate. The aggregate should be held as close as possible to the colour chips. Take care not to smear the broken surface, as this can give an incorrect recording of the colour of the soil matrix.
Dry colours may also be recorded.
Moisture status for colour description
M Moist
D Dry
MOTTLES AND OTHER COLOUR PATTERNSMottles are spots, blotches or streaks of subdominant colours different from the matrix colour and also different from the colour of the ped surface. Segregations of pedogenic origin are not considered to be mottles and are recorded elsewhere (page 195). Colour patterns due to biological or mechanical mixing and inclusions of weathered substrate material are described separately.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 159 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
160
Type
M Mottles
X Colour patterns due to biological mixing of soil material from other horizons (e.g. worm casts).
Y Colour patterns due to mechanical mixing of soil material from other horizons (e.g. inclusions of B horizon material in Ap horizons).
Z Colour patterns due to inclusions of weathered substrate material.
AbundanceThe percentage is estimated by eye using the chart in Figure 11 for comparison (see page 141).
0 No mottles or other colour patterns 01 Very few <2%2 Few 2–10%3 Common 10–20%4 Many 20–50%
SizeMeasure size along the greatest dimension, except in streaks or linear forms where width is measured.
1 Fine <5 mm2 Medium 5–15 mm3 Coarse 15–30 mm4 Very coarse >30 mm
Contrast
F Faint indistinct; evident only on close examination.D Distinct readily evident although not striking.P Prominent striking and conspicuous.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 160 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
161
ColourThis should be described in terms of Munsell or Revised Standard Soil colours, but the following abbreviated forms can be used:
R RedO OrangeB BrownY YellowG GreyD Dark values 3 or less and chromas 2 or less for all hues.L Gley gley charts only.P Pale values 7 or more and chromas 2 or less for all hues.
Distinctness of boundaries
S Sharp knife-edge boundary between colours.C Clear colour transition over less than 2 mm.D Diffuse colour transition over 2 mm or more.
FIELD TEXTURESoil texture is determined by the size distribution of mineral particles finer than 2 mm; that is, only material that will pass a 2 mm sieve should be used in determination of field texture. Organic soils are discussed on pages 169–70.
In Australia, field texture classes or field texture grades (Northcote 1979) are based on field determination of texture and not on laboratory determinations of particle size, as is done in USA for example (Soil Survey Staff 1975). There is only an approximate relationship between field texture and particle size distribution (see Marshall 1947), as factors other than clay, silt and sand content influence field texture.
Figure 15 gives a comparison between International particle size fractions, used in Australia, and those of other major classifications. Figure 16 is an example of a triangular texture diagram based on International fractions.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 161 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
162
RE
CO
MM
EN
DE
D S
CA
LE
FIN
EC
LAY
CLA
YF
INE
GR
AV
EL
ME
DIU
MG
RA
VE
LC
OA
RS
EG
RA
VE
LC
OB
BLE
SS
TO
NE
SB
OU
LDE
RS
SIL
TS
AN
DF
INE
CO
AR
SE
INT
ER
NA
TIO
NA
L
CLA
YG
RA
VE
LS
TO
NE
SS
ILT
SA
ND
FIN
EC
OA
RS
E
US
DE
PAR
TM
EN
T O
F A
GR
ICU
LTU
RE
CLA
YC
OB
BLE
SG
RA
VE
LS
TO
NE
SB
OU
LDE
RS
SA
ND
SIL
TF
INE
V-F
INE
FIN
EM
ED
CS
EV
-CS
EC
OA
RS
E
UN
IFIE
D (
CA
SA
GR
AN
DE
)
CLA
Y O
R S
ILT
CO
BB
LES
BO
ULD
ER
SS
AN
DG
RA
VE
LF
INE
FIN
EM
ED
IUM
CO
AR
SE
CO
AR
SE
PH
I SC
AL
E
0.02
0.00
20.
22.
06.
020
6020
0020
060
00.
0002
1110
98
76
54
32
10
-1-2
-3-4
-5-6
-7-8
-9-1
0
EQ
UIV
AL
EN
T A
US
TR
AL
IAN
STA
ND
AR
D S
IEV
E A
PE
RT
UR
ES
0.07
50.
212
0.6
2.36
6.7
1963
0.02
0.00
2<
0.00
020.
252.
020
2000
0.02
0.05
0.00
20.
10.
250.
51.
02.
076
2000
250
600
<0.
0002
0.07
40.
422.
04.
819
7620
0030
0<
0.00
02
Par
ticle
dia
met
ers
give
n in
mill
imet
res
unde
r ea
ch s
cale
Figu
re 1
5 Si
ze fr
actio
ns in
sev
eral
maj
or c
lass
ifica
tion
syst
ems.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 162 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
163
Mineral soilsThe following description of determination of field texture is adapted from Northcote (1979).
Field texture is a measure of the behaviour of a small handful of soil when moistened and kneaded into a ball and then pressed out between thumb and forefinger.
Take a sample of soil sufficient to fit comfortably into the palm of the hand. Moisten the soil with water, a little at a time, and knead until the ball of soil, so formed, just fails to stick to the fingers. Add more soil or water to attain this condition, known as the sticky point, which approximates field capacity for that soil. Continue kneading and moistening until there is no apparent change in
90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10
1090
2080
3070
4060
5050
6040
7030
8020
9010
Percent Sand
Percent Silt
Per
cent
Cla
y
100%CLAY
100%SILT
100%SAND
SANDYCLAY
SANDYCLAY
LOAM
SANDYLOAM
SAND
CLAY
SILTY CLAY
SILTY CLAY LOAM
LOAM SILTY LOAM
LOAMYSAND
CLAYLOAM
Figure 16 Triangular texture diagram based on International fractions (Marshall 1947).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 163 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
164
the soil ball, usually a working time of 1–2 minutes. The soil ball, or bolus, is now ready for shearing manipulation, but the behaviour of the soil during bolus formation is also indicative of its field texture. The behaviour of the bolus and of the ribbon produced by shearing (pressing out) between thumb and forefinger characterises the field texture. Do not assess field texture grade solely on the length of ribbon.
The recommended field texture grades as characterised by the behaviour of the moist bolus are set out below. The approximate percentage content of clay (particles <0.002 mm in diameter) and silt (particles 0.02–0.002 mm in diameter) are given as a guide. These percentages must not be used to determine a field texture; that is, do not use them to convert a laboratory particle size value to a field texture grade. Similarly, do not adjust a field texture grade when laboratory particle size data become available.
Field texture grade
Behaviour of moist bolus
Approximate clay content (%)
S Sand coherence nil to very slight, cannot be moulded; sand grains of medium size; single sand grains adhere to fingers.
commonly <5%
LS Loamy sand
slight coherence; sand grains of medium size; can be sheared between thumb and forefinger to give minimal ribbon of about 5 mm.
about 5%
CS Clayey sand
slight coherence; sand grains of medium size; sticky when wet; many sand grains stick to fingers; will form minimal ribbon of 5–15 mm; discolours fingers with clay stain.
5–10%
SL Sandy loam
bolus coherent but very sandy to touch; will form ribbon of 15–25 mm; dominant sand grains are of medium size and are readily visible.
10–20%
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 164 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
165
L Loam bolus coherent and rather spongy; smooth feel when manipulated but with no obvious sandiness or ‘silkiness’; may be somewhat greasy to the touch if much organic matter present; will form ribbon of about 25 mm.
about 25%
ZL Silty loam
coherent bolus; very smooth to often silky when manipulated; will form ribbon of about 25 mm.
about 25% and with silt 25% or more
SCL Sandy clay loam
strongly coherent bolus, sandy to touch; medium-size sand grains visible in finer matrix; will form ribbon of 25–40 mm.
20–30%
CL Clay loam
coherent plastic bolus, smooth to manipulate; will form ribbon of 40–50 mm.
30–35%
CLS Clay loam, sandy
coherent plastic bolus; medium-size sand grains visible in finer matrix; will form ribbon of 40–50 mm.
30–35%
ZCL Silty clay loam
coherent smooth bolus, plastic and often silky to the touch; will form ribbon of 40–50 mm.
30–35% and with silt 25% or more
LC Light clay
plastic bolus; smooth to touch; slight resistance to shearing between thumb and forefinger; will form ribbon of 50–75 mm.
35–40%
LMC Light medium clay
plastic bolus; smooth to touch; slight to moderate resistance to ribboning shear; will form ribbon of about 75 mm.
40–45%
MC Medium clay
smooth plastic bolus; handles like plasticine and can be moulded into rods without fracture; has moderate resistance to ribboning shear; will form ribbon of 75 mm or more.
45–55%
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 165 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
166
MHC Medium heavy clay
smooth plastic bolus; handles like plasticine; can be moulded into rods without fracture; has moderate to firm resistance to ribboning shear; will form ribbon of 75 mm or more.
50% or more
HC Heavy clay
smooth plastic bolus; handles like stiff plasticine; can be moulded into rods without fracture; has firm resistance to ribboning shear; will form ribbon of 75 mm or more.
50% or more
All the above field texture grades in which sand is recorded (e.g. LS, SL) are defined as having medium-sized sand. Coarse or fine sand grades can be given, as below:
K Coarse sandy coarse sand is obviously coarse to touch. Sand grains are very readily seen with the naked eye.
F Fine sandy fine sand can be felt and often heard when manipulated. Sand grains are clearly evident under a ×10 hand lens.
Record K or F immediately preceding S in the texture codes (e.g. LKS, KSL, CLFS).
Each of the clay field texture grades may also be modified according to the sand or silt fractions, where K is coarse sandy, S is medium sandy, F is fine sandy and Z is silty. These modifiers immediately precede the clay texture codes (e.g. KSLC for coarse sandy light clay; SLC for sandy light clay; ZLC for silty light clay).
Field texture qualificationThe non-clay field texture grades (clay loams and coarser) may be qualified according to whether they are at, or near, the light (lower clay content) or heavy (higher clay content) end of the range for that particular field texture grade. Note that codes on pages 165–6 provide for light and heavy qualifiers in the clays and hence – and + are not required.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 166 4/02/09 12:05:28 PM
Soil Profile
167
– Light+ Heavy
It is strongly recommended that this option be used only where considered essential. If too freely used, it can lead to excessive, unnecessary detail of doubtful usefulness.
If the soils are appreciably organic, they are qualified thus:
A Sapric organic and non-fibrous; dark organic stain discolours fingers; greasy feel in clayey textures and coherence in sandy textures. Fibres (excluding living roots) or plant tissue remains are not visible to naked eye and little or none visible with ×10 hand lens.
I Fibric organic and fibrous; dark organic stain discolours fingers; greasy feel in clayey textures and coherence in sandy textures. Fibres (excluding living roots) or plant tissue remain visible to naked eye or easily visible with ×10 hand lens.
These codes are given after the field texture. For example, light sandy clay loam is coded SCL–, heavy sandy clay loam is coded SCL+, and fibric sandy loam is coded SLI.
Soil properties affecting determination of field texture gradeSeveral soil properties affect field texture. These include:
Clay (particles less than 0.002 mm in diameter) confers cohesion, stickiness and plasticity to the bolus and increases its resistance to deformation.The type of clay mineral influences the tractability of the bolus. Montmorillonitic clays tend to make the bolus resist deformation and therefore it can be stiff to ribbon. Thus, a long ribbon may suggest a finer (more clayey) field texture than the percentage clay content would indicate. By contrast, kaolinitic clays make the field texture appear less
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 167 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
168
clayey than the percentage clay content would indicate, as they tend to produce a short thin ribbon from the bolus.Silt (particles 0.002–0.02 mm in diameter) often confers a silky smoothness on field textures, as it fills in the particle size range between sand (particles >0.02 mm in diameter) and clay.Organic matter confers cohesion to sandy field textures and a greasiness to clayey field textures; it tends to produce a short thick ribbon from the bolus. Some soils containing about 40–50% clay-sized particles and sufficient organic matter (>20%) will behave as clay loams and light clays instead of medium or heavy clays. Large amounts of organic matter in dry soils may resist wetting and make bolus preparation difficult.When present in significant amounts, oxides – chiefly those of iron and aluminium – may require extra water for the soil to form the bolus. This may shear readily to produce a short ribbon, indicating a less clayey field texture than the clay content suggests. Such soil materials are subplastic.Calcium and magnesium carbonates in the fine earth fraction (particles <2 mm in diameter) will usually impart a porridge-like consistency to the bolus. They tend to increase the apparent clay content of sandy and loamy field textures such that amounts of 10–30% calcium carbonate cause the field texture to increase about one grade above that obtained when the carbonates are removed from the fine earth fraction. Carbonates may also make clay field textures appear less clayey by shortening the ribbon produced from the bolus.Cation composition. In general, calcium-dominant clays accept water readily and are easy to knead and smooth to field texture. Sodium-dominant and magnesium-dominant clays, however, are often difficult to wet and knead, producing a slimy, tough bolus, resistant to shearing and often appearing to have a more clayey field texture than would be indicated by the actual clay content.Strong, fine-structural aggregation will tend to cause an underestimation of clay content, due to the incomplete breakdown of the structural units during bolus preparation. Longer and more vigorous kneading is necessary to produce a homogeneous bolus.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 168 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
169
The above properties occur in soils to differing degrees and specific allowance cannot be made for them. Field texture must remain a subjective but reproducible measure of the behaviour of a handful of soil moistened and kneaded into an adequately prepared bolus and subjected to shearing manipulation between thumb and forefinger. However, this method provides a very useful assessment of the physical behaviour of soil in the field.
Organic soilsStrictly speaking, organic soils do not have textural names, as soil texture is determined by the size of mineral particles finer than 2 mm (page 161). In a sense, organic soils do have a texture related to the plant materials from which they formed and the degree of decomposition, exposure and drying.
The following names may be used to characterise materials that on field examination are considered to be clearly dominated by organic matter.
Peats may be assessed by examining the degree of decomposition and distinctness of plant remains. The following is adapted from Soil Survey Staff (1975) and Avery (1980):
IP Fibric peat (fibrous peat) undecomposed or weakly decomposed organic material. Plant remains are distinct and readily identifiable.
HP Hemic peat (semi-fibrous peat) moderately to well-decomposed organic material. Plant remains vary from most being difficult to identify to most being unidentifiable. It is intermediate in degree of decomposition between the less decomposed fibric peat and the more decomposed sapric peat.
AP Sapric peat (humified peat) strongly to completely decomposed organic material. Plant remains vary from few being identifiable to completely amorphous.
SP Sandy peat bolus is sandy to touch.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 169 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
170
LP Loamy peat bolus has obvious mineral particle content but no obvious sandiness to touch and is smooth, non-sticky when wet, and weakly coherent.
CP Clayey peat bolus has obvious fine mineral particle content, is sticky when wet, and is coherent.
On drying, peat may change irreversibly.
GP Granular peat dominantly decomposed organic material, which has dried irreversibly to fine granules through exposure and drying and/or cultivation. Granules are about 1–2 mm in diameter and have granular or subangular blocky structure.
COARSE FRAGMENTSCoarse fragments may occur throughout the profile. Their abundance, size, shape, lithology and strength are described in exactly the same way as are coarse fragments on the surface (see page 139); in addition, their distribution is described.
Coarse fragment distribution
U Undisturbed all fragments are remnants of the underlying bedrock and their orientation closely parallels that of the joint or bedding planes of the bedrock.
R Reoriented all fragments are remnants of the underlying bedrock but their orientation is not related to the joint or bedding planes of the bedrock.
S Stratified fragments occur in bands, usually parallel with the soil surface (excluding those parallel with joint or bedding planes of the bedrock). They may include materials other than those from the underlying bedrock.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 170 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
171
D Dispersed fragments are scattered randomly throughout the soil and may be of mixed origin.
STRUCTURESoil structure refers to the distinctness, size and shape of peds. A ped is an individual natural soil aggregate consisting of a cluster of primary particles. Peds are separated from adjoining peds by surfaces of weakness that are recognisable as natural voids or by the occurrence of cutans (Brewer 1960).
Soil structure can only be described reliably in a relatively fresh vertical exposure or relatively undisturbed soil core, not from an auger boring. Vertical exposures that have been exposed for a long time (road cuttings, gullies) are unsuitable for the determination of structure that may alter due to daily or seasonal changes in moisture and temperature.
Grade of pedalityGrade of pedality is the degree of development and distinctness of peds. In virtually all material that has structure, the surface of individual peds will differ in some way from the interior of peds. The degree of development expresses the relative difference between the strength of cohesion within peds and the strength of adhesion between adjacent peds. Determination of grade of structure in the field depends on the proportion of peds that hold together as entire peds when displaced and also on the ease with which the soil separates into discrete peds.
Grade of pedality varies with the soil water status. It is important to record the soil water status of the described profile, and it is desirable to describe the grade of pedality at the soil water status most common for the horizon.
Apedal soils have no observable peds and are divided into:
G Single grain loose, incoherent13 mass of individual particles. When displaced, soil separates into ultimate particles.
13 Incoherent means that less than two-thirds of the soil material will remain united at the given moisture state without very small force (force 1, see ‘Consistence’ on page 186) having been applied.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 171 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
172
V Massive coherent.14 When displaced, soil separates into fragments (see page 181), which may be crushed to ultimate particles.
Pedal soils have observable peds and are divided into:
W Weak peds indistinct and barely observable in undisplaced soil. When displaced, up to one-third of the soil material consists of peds, the remainder consisting of variable amounts of fragments and ultimate particles.
M Moderate peds well-formed and evident but not distinct in undisplaced soil. Adhesion between peds is usually firm or stronger. When displaced, more than one-third of the soil material consists of entire peds, the remainder consisting of broken peds, fragments and ultimate particles.
S Strong peds quite distinct in undisplaced soil. Adhesion between peds is usually firm or weaker. When displaced, more than two-thirds of the soil material consists of entire peds.
Size of pedsThe average least dimension of peds is used to determine the class interval. Use Figure 17 on pages 174–9 as a guide.
The least dimension is the vertical dimension for platy structure; the horizontal dimension for prismatic, columnar, blocky and polyhedral peds; the maximum separation of convex faces for lenticular peds; and the diameter for granular peds.
1 <2 mm
2 2–5 mm
3 5–10 mm
14 Coherent means that two-thirds or more of the soil material will remain united at the given moisture state unless force is applied.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 172 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
173
4 10–20 mm5 20–50 mm6 50–100 mm7 100–200 mm8 200–500 mm9 >500 mm
Type of pedalityThe types of structure are described below. Figure 17 illustrates these in diagrammatic form.
PL Platy soil particles arranged around a horizontal plane and bounded by relatively flat horizontal faces with much accommodation to the faces of surrounding peds.
PR Prismatic soil particles arranged around a vertical axis and bounded by well-defined, relatively flat faces with much accommodation to the faces of surrounding peds. Vertices between adjoining faces are usually angular.
CO Columnar as for prismatic but with domed tops.
AB Angular blocky
soil particles arranged around a point and bounded by six relatively flat, roughly equal faces. Re-entrant angles between adjoining faces are few or absent. There is usually much accommodation of ped faces to the faces of surrounding peds. Most vertices between adjoining faces are angular.
SB Subangular blocky
similar to angular blocky except peds are bounded by flat and rounded faces with limited accommodation to the faces of surrounding peds. Many vertices are rounded.
PO Polyhedral soil particles arranged around a point and bounded by more than six relatively flat, unequal, dissimilar faces. Re-entrant angles between adjoining faces are a feature. There is usually much accommodation of ped faces to the faces of surrounding peds. Most vertices are angular.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 173 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
174
1 <2 mm thick
2 2 –5 mm
3 5 –10 mm
4 >10 mm
Platy Peds
Figure 17 Ped size.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 174 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
175
3 5–10 mm wide
5 20 –50 mm
6 50 –100 mm
7 >100 mm
4 10 –20 mm
Prismatic and Columnar Peds
Figure 17 (continued) Ped size.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 175 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
176
2 2–5 mm wide
3 5 –10 mm
4 10 –20 mm
5 20–50 mm
6 >50 mm
Angular and Subangular Blocky Peds
Figure 17 (continued) Ped size.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 176 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
177
2 2–5 mm wide
3 5 –10 mm
4 10 –20 mm
5 20 –50 mm
6 >50 mm
Polyhedral Peds
Figure 17 (continued) Ped size.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 177 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
2 2–5 mm length of short axis
3 5 –10 mm
4 10 –20 mm
5 20–50 mm
6 >50 mm
Lenticular Peds
Figure 17 (continued) Ped size.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 178 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
179
1 <2 mm diameter
2 2–5 mm
3 5–10 mm
4 >10 mm
Granular Peds
Figure 17 (continued) Ped size.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 179 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
180
LE Lenticular soil particles arranged around an elliptical or circular plane and bounded by curved faces with much accommodation to the faces of surrounding peds. Most vertices are angular and acute.
GR Granular spheroidal with limited accommodation to the faces of surrounding peds.
CA Cast although faunal casts are strictly not peds, they may be described in a similar manner. They are formed from, or are deposited in, the O horizons or the soil solum and include:
excreta of soil fauna which may be discrete particles, for example insect faeces or the dense, coherent, globular forms of earthworm excreta. They are generally spherical or ovate in shape and have a strong conchoidal fracture.soil masticated with salivary secretions into globular forms, for example, by ants, crickets, wasps.
Compound pedalityCompound pedality occurs where large peds part along natural planes of weakness to form smaller peds, which may again part to smaller peds, and so on to the smallest or primary peds.
Primary peds are the simplest peds occurring in soil material; they cannot be divided into smaller peds, but may be packed together to form compound peds of a higher level of organisation (Brewer 1964).
The order of peds and relationship of one to the other is important and may be described as the larger peds parting to the smaller and further where necessary. For example, ‘strong 50–100 mm columnar, parting to moderate 20–50 mm prismatic, parting to moderate 10–20 mm angular blocky’. The word ‘parting’ and not ‘breaking’ is used. The term ‘breaking’ is used when soil is fractured along planes other than natural planes of weakness.
1 Largest peds (in the type of soil observation described), parting to2 Next size peds, parting to3 Next size peds, ... and further, if required, to the primary ped.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 180 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
181
Clods and fragmentsCultivated horizons (Ap horizons) often consist of artificial aggregates formed by cultivation or work being done on the soil. The distinction between artificial aggregates and peds can be difficult. In cultivated horizons, where the pedologist is confident the aggregates are natural peds, they should be recorded as such. If the pedologist is doubtful, or the aggregates are obviously artificial, they should be recorded as clods or fragments.
CL Clod artificial aggregate with diameter 100 mm or more.FR Fragment artificial aggregate with diameter less than 100 mm.
FABRICThe definition of soil fabric in Australia is incomplete. The following description is adapted from Northcote (1979).
Fabric describes the appearance of the soil material (under ×10 hand lens). Differences in fabric are associated with the presence or absence of peds, the lustre or lack of lustre of the ped surfaces, and the presence, size and arrangement of pores (voids) in the soil mass. The descriptions given below apply primarily to B horizons.
Earthy (or porous) fabricThe soil material is coherent and characterised by the presence of pores (voids) and few, if any, peds. Ultimate soil particles (sand grains, for example) are coated with oxides and/or clays and are arranged (clumped) around the pores.
Sandy fabricThe soil material is coherent, with few, if any, peds. The closely packed sand grains provide the characteristic appearance of the soil mass.
Rough-ped fabricPeds are evident, and characteristically more than 50% of the peds are rough-faced (i.e. they have relatively porous surfaces). (Rough-faced peds generally have less clearly defined faces than smooth-faced peds and the pedality of the soil may be questioned. However, if the soil mass is pressed gently, the characteristic size and shape of the soil aggregates will confirm its pedality.)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 181 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
182
Granular peds with common or many macropores are always rough-faced, but this condition varies in other ped forms.
Smooth-ped fabricPeds are evident, and characteristically more than 50% of them are dense and smooth-faced, although the degree of lustre may vary.
E EarthyG Sandy (grains prominent)R Rough-pedS Smooth-ped
CUTANSA cutan is a modification of the texture, structure or fabric at natural surfaces in soil materials; it arises from concentration of particular soil constitutents or in situ modification of the plasma. Cutans comprise any of the component substances of the soil material (Brewer 1964).
Cutans may be observed in the field (a ×10 hand lens is usually necessary) but their nature is often difficult to determine unless a thin section is made. Hence, the following simple classification.
Types of cutans
Z Zero or no cutans
U Unspecified nature of cutans cannot be determined.
C Clay skins coatings of clay often different in colour from the matrix of the ped. They are frequently difficult to distinguish from stress cutans, which are not true coatings.
M Mangans coatings of manganese oxides or hydroxides. The material may have a glazed appearance and is very dark brown to black.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 182 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
183
S Stress cutans in situ modifications of natural surfaces in soil materials due to differential forces such as shearing. They are not true coatings.
K Slickensides stress cutans with smooth striations or grooves.
O Other cutans may be composed of iron oxides, organic matter, calcium carbonate or gypsum.
Abundance of cutans0 No cutans 01 Few <10% of ped faces or pore walls with cutans.2 Common 10–50% of ped faces or pore walls with cutans.3 Many >50% of ped faces or pore walls with cutans.
Distinctness of cutansThis refers to the ease and certainty with which a cutan is identified. Distinctness relates to thickness and to the colour contrast with the adjacent material; it may change markedly with moisture content.
F Faint evident only on close examination with ×10 magnification. Little contrast with adjacent material.
D Distinct can be detected without magnification. Contrast with adjacent material is evident in colour, texture or other properties.
P Prominent conspicuous without magnification when compared with a surface broken through the soil. Colour, texture or some other property contrasts sharply with properties of the adjacent material, or the feature is thick enough to be conspicuous.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 183 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
184
VOIDSThis is a general term for pore space and other openings in soils not occupied by solid mineral matter. The most important are cracks (planar voids) and pores, which are approximately circular in cross-section.
CracksWidth
1 Fine <5 mm2 Medium 5–10 mm3 Coarse 10–20 mm4 Very coarse 20–50 mm5 Extremely coarse >50 mm
PoresPores are divided into:
Micropores less than 0.075 mm diameterMacropores greater than 0.075 mm diameter
Only macropores can be seen with the naked eye (Figure 18). All visible pores, holes and tubes within peds, clods, fragments or apedal soil are recorded in the classes below.
Abundance of macroporesThere are two groups:
Very fine and fine macropores (less than 2 mm diameter)
0 No very fine or fine macropores
1 Few <1 per 100 mm2 (10 mm × 10 mm)2 Common 1–5 per 100 mm2 (10 mm × 10 mm)3 Many >5 per 100 mm2 (10 mm × 10 mm)
Medium and coarse macropores (greater than 2 mm diameter)
0 No medium or coarse macropores
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 184 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
185
4 Few <1 per 0.01 m2 (100 mm × 100 mm)5 Common 1–5 per 0.01 m2 (100 mm × 100 mm)6 Many >5 per 0.01 m2 (100 mm × 100 mm)
Diameter of macroporesUse Figure 18 as a guide to average diameter.
1 Very fine 0.075–1 mm2 Fine 1–2 mm3 Medium 2–5 mm4 Coarse >5 mm
Very fine<1 mm
Fine1–2 mm
Medium2–5 mm
Coarse>5 mm
Size of Macropores
Figure 18 Size of macropores.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 185 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
186
SOIL WATER STATUSGive soil water status of the soil at the time of description (Table 30).
It may also be relevant to note the weather conditions immediately prior to examination of the soil if these are known; for example a soil may be wet because of local rain or from seepage.
The following guidelines may be used as a crude approximation of soil water status:
Dry is below wilting point. Material becomes darker or has lower colour value when moistened.Moderately moist is the drier half of the available moisture range.Moist is the wetter half of the available moisture range.Wet is at, or exceeding, field capacity. Will wet and/or stick to fingers when moulded.
These guidelines may not apply with sodic 2:1 clays, as, for example, they may be moderately moist but below wilting point.
CONSISTENCEConsistence refers to the strength of cohesion and adhesion in soil. Strength will vary according to soil water status. Note that soil water status must be recorded with strength.
Table 30 Soil water status
Behaviour of soils subjected to field test
Soil water status Sands, sandy loams Loams Clay loams, clays
D Dry will flow through fingers or fragments will powder.
will not ball when squeezed in hand. Fragments will powder.
will not ball when squeezed in hand. Fragments will break to smaller fragments or peds.
T Moderately moist
appears dry. Ball will not hold together.
forms crumbly ball on squeezing in hand.
will ball. Will not ribbon.
M Moist forms weak ball but breaks easily.
will ball. Will not ribbon.
will ball. Will ribbon easily.
W Wet ball leaves wet outline on hand when squeezed, or is wetter.
ball leaves wet outline on hand when squeezed, or is wetter. Sticky.
ball leaves wet outline on hand when squeezed, or is wetter. Sticky.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 186 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
187
StrengthStrength of soil is the resistance to breaking or deformation. Strength is determined by the force just sufficient to break or deform a 20 mm diameter piece of soil when a compressive shearing force is applied between thumb and forefinger. The 20 mm piece of soil may be a ped, part of a ped, a compound ped or a fragment.
Force15
0 Loose no force required. Separate particles such as loose sands.
1 Very weak very small force, almost nil.
2 Weak small but significant force.
3 Firm moderate or firm force.
4 Very firm strong force but within power of thumb and forefinger.
5 Strong beyond power of thumb and forefinger. Crushes underfoot on hard, flat surface with small force.
6 Very strong crushes underfoot on hard, flat surface with full body weight applied slowly.
7 Rigid cannot be crushed underfoot by full body weight applied slowly.
StickinessStickiness is determined on wet soil by pressing the wet sample between thumb and forefinger and then observing the adherence of the soil to the fingers.
15 Forces 0 to 5 are equivalent to the following dry consistence classes in the USDA soil survey manual (Soil Survey Staff 1951):
0 Loose 3 Hard1 Soft 4 Very hard2 Slightly hard 5 Extremely hard
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 187 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
188
0 Non-sticky little or no soil adheres.
1 Slightly sticky soil adheres to thumb and forefinger but is not stretched notably and comes off rather cleanly.
2 Moderately sticky soil adheres to thumb and forefinger and tends to stretch rather than pull free of fingers.
3 Very sticky soil adheres strongly to thumb and forefinger and stretches notably.
Type of plasticityThe type of plasticity refers to the degree to which the either the consistence, field texture or both properties of a soil suggest the amount of clay-sized particles it contains (Butler 1955). It may be identified by determining two field textures: one after an initial 1 to 2 minute working of the soil sample, and another after a prolonged 10 minute kneading. The change in field texture from the initial to the prolonged working of the soil sample indicates the type of plasticity.
Field texture change after 10 minute kneadingS Superplastic decreases one or more field texture groups of
Northcote (1979).N Normal plasticity negligible change.U Subplastic increases one to two field texture groups.T Strongly
subplasticincreases two or more field texture groups.
Degree of plasticityPlasticity is the ability to change shape and retain the new shape after the stress is removed.
The degree of plasticity given below applies only to normal plasticity.The degree of plasticity is determined at the soil moisture content used for
field texturing (i.e. just below sticky point). The soil is rolled between the palms of the hand and, if possible, 40 mm long rolls are formed. The rolls are dangled
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 188 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
189
from the thumb and forefinger. Plasticity is determined on the following scale of behaviour of rolls of varying thickness.
Dimensions and behaviour of rollsLength Diameter Behaviour
0 Non-plastic 40 mm 6 mm will not form.
1 Slightly plastic
40 mm 6 mm will form and will support its own weight.
40 mm 4 mm will form but will not support its own weight.
2 Moderately plastic
40 mm 4 mm will form and will support its own weight.
40 mm 2 mm will form but will not support its own weight.
3 Very plastic 40 mm 2 mm will form and will support its own weight.
CONDITION OF SURFACE SOIL WHEN DRYMany surface soils have a characteristic appearance when dry. Because surface conditions are often relevant to the use of the soil and indicative of particular kinds of soil, every effort should be made to observe the surface condition in the dry state. The following conditions are not necessarily mutually exclusive:
G Cracking cracks at least 5 mm wide and extending upwards to the surface or to the base of any plough layer or thin (<0.03 m) surface horizon.
M Self-mulching strongly pedal loose surface mulch forms on wetting and drying. Peds commonly less than 5 mm in least dimension.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 189 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
190
L Loose incoherent16 mass of individual particles or aggregates. Surface easily disturbed by pressure of forefinger.
S Soft coherent17 mass of individual particles or aggregates. Surface easily disturbed by pressure of forefinger.
F Firm coherent17 mass of individual particles or aggregates. Surface disturbed or indented by moderate pressure of forefinger.
H Hard setting compact, hard, apparently apedal condition forms on drying but softens on wetting. When dry, the material is hard below any surface crust or flake that may occur, and is not disturbed or indented by pressure of forefinger.
C Surface crust distinct surface layer, often laminated, ranging in thickness from a few millimetres to a few tens of millimetres, which is hard and brittle when dry and cannot be readily separated from, and lifted off, the underlying soil material.
X Surface flake thin, massive surface layer, usually less than 10 mm thick, which on drying separates from, and can be readily lifted off, the soil below. It usually consists mainly of dispersed clay, and may become increasingly fragile as the soil dries.
Y Cryptogam thin, more or less continuous crust of biologically surface stabilised soil material usually due to algae,
liverworts and mosses.
16 Incoherent means that less than two-thirds of the soil material, whether composed of peds or not, will remain united at the given moisture state without very small force (force 1, see ‘Consistence’ on page 186) having been applied.
17 Coherent means that two-thirds of the soil material, whether composed of peds or not, will remain united at the given moisture state unless force is applied.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 190 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Soil Profile
191
T Trampled soil that has been extensively trampled under dry conditions by hoofed animals.
P Poached soil that has been extensively trampled under wet conditions by hoofed animals.
R Recently effect of cultivation is obvious. cultivated
Z Saline surface has visible salt, or salinity is evident from the absence or nature of the vegetation or from soil consistence. These conditions are characterised by their notable difference from adjacent non-saline areas.
O Other
WATER REPELLENCEWater repellence of some soils, usually sandy, is caused by a series of long-chain polymethylene waxes, made up of acids, alcohols and esters, attached to the sand grains (Ma’shum et al. 1988). These soils occur Australia-wide but are more widespread in southern Australia (McGhie and Posner 1980; Wetherby 1984). Degree of repellence is assessed by determining the concentration of ethanol required to wet the sand in 10 seconds (King 1981). An abbreviated form of this method is recommended for routine field situations.
N Non water repellent
water is absorbed into soil in 10 seconds or less.
R Water repellent
water takes greater than 10 seconds and 2 Molar ethanol takes 10 seconds or less to be absorbed into soil.
S Strongly water repellent
2 Molar ethanol takes greater than 10 seconds to be absorbed into soil.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 191 4/02/09 12:05:29 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
192
Note: Soil temperature at testing should be between 15ºC and 25ºC. Higher temperatures will increase, and lower decrease, rates of absorption. Industrial-grade methylated spirits, available from chemists, at a concentration of 23.9 mL per 200 mL water can be substituted for the 2 Molar ethanol to obtain approximate values.
PANSA pan is an indurated and/or cemented soil horizon.
Cementation of panPlace a 30 mm diameter piece of the pan in water for 1 hour. If it slakes, it is uncemented; if not, it is cemented. The degree of cementation is assessed on the following scale after the 1 hour soaking in water.
0 Uncemented slakes.
1 Weakly cemented can be crushed between thumb and forefinger.
2 Moderately cemented
beyond power of thumb and forefinger. Crushes underfoot on hard, flat surface with weight of average person (80 kg) applied slowly.
3 Strongly cemented cannot be crushed underfoot by weight of average person applied slowly. Can be broken by hammer.
4 Very strongly cemented
cannot be broken by hammer, or only with extreme difficulty.
Type of pan
Z Zero or no pan
K Calcrete any cemented, terrestrial carbonate accumulation that may vary significantly in morphology and degree of cementation. Also known as carbonate pan, calcareous pan, caliche, kunkar, secondary
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 192 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Soil Profile
193
limestone, travertine. All show slight to strong effervescence with 1 Molar HCl.
L Silcrete strongly indurated siliceous material cemented by, and largely composed of, forms of silica, including quartz, chalcedony, opal and chert.
R Red-brown earthy pan, which is normally reddish brown to hardpan red with dense yet porous appearance; it is very
hard, has an irregular laminar cleavage and some vertical cracks, and varies from less than 0.3 m to over 30 m thick. Other variable features are bedded and unsorted sand and gravel lenses; wavy black veinings, probably manganiferous; and, less commonly, off-white veins of calcium carbonate. (The presence of calcium carbonate is not common and the red-brown hardpan in which it occurs may be relatively brittle and finely laminar.) The red-brown hardpan is usually present below the soil profile and is not a feature of any particular soil group. (It has some similarity with other silica pans such as duripans of arid climates). In many instances, it is not known if the red-brown hardpan is a paleosol or a cemented sediment (Wright 1983). If thought to be the latter, it may be described as a substrate material (page 205).
D Duripan earthy pan so cemented by silica that dry fragments do not slake in water and are always brittle, even after prolonged wetting. (Described by Soil Survey Staff 1975.)
F Fragipan earthy pan, which is usually loamy. A dry fragment slakes in water. A wet fragment does not slake in water but has moderate or weak brittleness. Fragipans are more stable on exposure than overlying or underlying horizons. (Described by Soil Survey Staff 1975.)
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 193 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
194
N Densipan earthy pan, which is very fine sandy (0.02–0.05 mm). Fragments, both wet and dry, slake in water. Densipans are less stable on exposure than overlying or underlying horizons. (Described by Smith et al. 1975.)
I Thin ironpan commonly thin (2–10 mm), black to dark reddish pan cemented by iron, iron and manganese, or iron–organic matter complexes. Rarely 40 mm thick. Has wavy or convolute form and usually occurs as a single pan. This is a placic horizon (described by Soil Survey Staff 1975, page 33).
E Ferricrete indurated material rich in hydrated oxides of iron (usually goethite and hematite) occurring as cemented nodules and/or concretions, or as massive sheets. This material has been commonly referred to in local usage around Australia as laterite, duricrust or ironstone.
A Alcrete (bauxite) indurated material rich in aluminium hydroxides. Commonly consists of cemented pisoliths and usually known as bauxite.
M Manganiferous indurated material dominated by oxides of pan manganese.
T Ortstein horizon strongly cemented by iron and organic matter. It has marked local variability in colour, both laterally and vertically. It may occur in the B horizon of podzols.
C Organic pan horizon relatively high in organic matter but low in iron. It is relatively thick and weakly to strongly cemented by aluminium and usually becomes progressively more cemented with depth. It is usually relatively uniform in appearance laterally. It is commonly the B horizon of humus podzols, where it is often known as coffee rock or sandrock.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 194 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Soil Profile
195
V Cultivation pan subsurface soil horizon having higher bulk density, lower total porosity, and lower permeability to both air and water than horizons directly above and below as a result of cultivation practices. (After Morse et al. 1987.)
O Other pans
Continuity of pan
C Continuous extends as a layer with little or no break across 1 m or more.
D Discontinuous broken by cracks but original orientation of fragments is preserved.
B Broken broken by cracks and fragments are disoriented.
Structure of pan
V Massive no recognisable structure.
S Vesicular sponge-like structure having large pores, which may or may not be filled with softer material.
C Concretionary spheroidal concretions cemented together.
N Nodular nodules of irregular shape cemented together.
L Platy plate-like units cemented together.
R Vermicular worm-like structure and/or cavities.
SEGREGATIONS OF PEDOGENIC ORIGINThis refers to discrete segregations that have accumulated in the soil because of the concentration of some constituent, usually by chemical or biological action.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 195 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
196
Segregations may be relict or formed in situ by current pedogenic processes.
Abundance of segregationsUse Figure 11 as a guide (see page 141).
0 No segregations 01 Very few <2%2 Few 2–10%3 Common 10–20%4 Many 20–50%5 Very many >50%
Nature of segregations
U UnidentifiedK Calcareous (carbonate)Y Gypseous (gypsum)M Manganiferous (manganese)N Ferromanganiferous (iron–manganese)F Ferruginous (iron)A Aluminous (aluminium)S Sulfurous (sulfur) (e.g. in acid sulfate soils)Z Saline (visible salt)H Organic (humified, well-decomposed organic matter)G Ferruginous–organic (iron–organic matter)L Argillaceous (clayey)E Earthy (dominantly non-clayey)O Other
Form of segregations
C Concretions spheroidal mineral aggregates. Crudely concentric internal fabric can be seen with naked eye. Includes pisoliths and ooliths.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 196 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Soil Profile
197
N Nodules irregular, rounded mineral aggregates. No concentric or symmetric internal fabric. Can have hollow interior.
F Fragments broken pieces of segregations.
X Crystals single or complex clusters of crystals visible with naked eye or ×10 hand lens.
S Soft segregations finely divided soft segregations. They contrast with surrounding soil in colour and composition but are not easily separated as discrete bodies. Boundaries may be clearly defined or diffuse.
V Veins fine (<2 mm wide) linear segregations.
R Root linings linings of former or current root channels.
T Tubules medium or coarser (>2 mm wide) tube-like segregations, which may or may not be hollow.
L Laminae planar, plate-like or sheet-like segregations.
Size of segregationsApproximately equidimensional segregations (concretions, nodules) are measured in the greatest dimension. Segregations where one dimension is much greater than the other two (tubules, root linings, veins, laminae) are measured in the least dimension.
1 Fine <2 mm2 Medium 2–6 mm3 Coarse 6–20 mm4 Very coarse 20–60 mm5 Extremely coarse >60 mm
Strength of segregationsStrength may be recorded where appropriate.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 197 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
198
1 Weak can be broken between thumb and forefinger.2 Strong cannot be broken between thumb and forefinger.
Magnetic attributes of segregations
N Non-magnetic not attracted onto surface of hand-held magnet.M Magnetic attracted onto surface of hand-held magnet.
EFFERVESCENCE OF CARBONATE IN FINE EARTHa
N Non-calcareous no audible or visible effervescence.
S Slightly calcareous slightly audible but no visible effervescence.
M Moderately calcareous
audible and slightly visible effervescence.
H Highly calcareous moderate visible effervescence.
V Very highly calcareous
strong visible effervescence.
a Using two or three drops of 1 Molar HCl.
FIELD pHThe soil pH is determined in the field using a field pH kit based on the specifications of Raupach and Tucker (1959). Estimate to 0.5 of a unit. Portable pH meters may also be used.
Record depth at which pH is determined, in metres. The pH may be measured either:
by horizons, orwhere horizons are thick (>0.5 m) and horizon boundaries are diffuse, at selected intervals down the profile. This system gives useful data in some soils when important pH changes may occur independently of visible horizon changes (e.g. the change from alkaline to strongly acid conditions in some cracking clays).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 198 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Soil Profile
199
ROOTSRecord the presence of roots observed in each horizon in areas 100 mm square on a cleaned exposure face.
Root size
Diameter1 Very fine <1 mm2 Fine 1–2 mm3 Medium 2–5 mm4 Coarse >5 mm
Root abundance
Table 31 Root abundance
Number of roots per 0.01 m2 (100 mm × 100 mm)
Very fine and fine roots Medium and coarse roots
0 No roots 0 0
1 Few 1–10 1–2
2 Common 10–25 2–5
3 Many 25–200 >5
4 Abundant >200 >5
BOUNDARIES BETWEEN HORIZONSBoundary distinctness
Width of boundaryS Sharp <5 mmA Abrupt 5–20 mmC Clear 20–50 mmG Gradual 50–100 mmD Diffuse >100 mm
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 199 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
200
Boundary shape
S Smooth almost a plane surface.W Wavy undulations with depressions wider than they
are deep.I Irregular undulations with depressions deeper than they
are wide.T Tongued depressions considerably deeper than they are
wide.B Broken discontinuous.
SOIL WATER REGIMETraditional approaches to soil drainage do not adequately differentiate between hydrological setting and permeability of the material of the profile. For example, a very permeable, coarse-textured soil occurring in a wet depression would have to be classed as very poorly drained. Hence, there is a need to consider permeability, which refers to the potential of a soil to transmit water internally, and drainage, which refers to the rapidity and extent of water removal from the soil profile or site. Both these aspects of internal drainage may be difficult to assess in the field, and cannot be based solely on profile morphology. Mottling may, but not always, reflect drainage status, since mottling may be a relict feature. Vegetation and topography may be useful guides.
The concepts of permeability and drainage given below are largely based on Canada Soil Survey Committee (1978).
Soil permeabilityPermeability is independent of climate and drainage, and – as applied to a soil – is controlled by the potential to transmit water (saturated hydraulic conductivity, Ks) of the least permeable layer in the soil. Therefore it is inferred from attributes of the soil such as structure, texture, porosity, cracks and shrink–swell properties. In the classes given below, the rate of transmission of water in the profile is based on the assumption that loss by evapotranspiration is minimal. The Ks ranges are compatible with those of Nowland in Canada, as reported by McKeague et al. (1982).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 200 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Soil Profile
201
1 Very slowly permeable
Ks range: <5 mm/day
Drainage time: months
vertical transmission of water in the least permeable horizon is very slow; the profile would take a month or more after thorough wetting to reach field capacity if there were no obstructions to movement from the profile. Structure may vary, but cracks or spaces between peds when dry close on wetting. Texture is usually clay or silty clay, and there are no pores visible (with a hand lens) that could conduct water when wet.
2 Slowly permeable
Ks range: 5–50 mm/day
Drainage time: weeks
vertical transmission of water in the least permeable horizon is slow; the profile would take a week or more after thorough wetting to reach field capacity if there were no obstructions to movement from the profile. Structure may vary, usually from massive to moderate grade. Texture is usually clay or silty clay, and there will be few pores visible (with a hand lens) that conduct water when wet. If texture is coarser, the interparticle voids are filled with fine mineral.
3 Moderately permeable
Ks range: 50–500 mm/day
Drainage time: days
vertical transmission of water in the least permeable horizon is such that the profile would take no more than 1–5 days after a thorough wetting to reach field capacity if there were no obstructions to water movement from the profile. The soil may vary in structure but grade is usually at least moderate, and blocky or polyhedral peds are common. If massive, the soil material is always porous. The pores and channels that remain open when wet are clearly visible with a hand lens.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 201 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
202
4 Highly permeable
Ks range: >500 mm/day
Drainage time: hours
vertical transmission of water in the least permeable horizon is such that the profile would take no more than 1–12 hours after a thorough wetting to reach field capacity if there were no obstructions to water movement from the profile. Horizons have large, continuous and clearly visible connecting pores and cracks that do not close with wetting. Texture is usually sandy and nodules or gravel are commonly present. Soil horizons are usually apedal, but some medium-textured to fine-textured soils with strong granular structure or cementation of aggregates can be highly permeable.
Although Ks data are limited for Australian soils, values for some well-known soils may be found in Bonell et al. (1983), Talsma (1983) and Williams (1983).
DrainageDrainage is a useful term to summarise local soil wetness conditions; that is, it provides a statement about soil and site drainage likely to occur in most years. It is affected by several attributes, both internal and external, that may act separately or together. Internal attributes include soil structure, texture, porosity, hydraulic conductivity and water-holding capacity, while external attributes are source and quality of water, evapotranspiration, gradient and length of slope, and position in the landscape.
1 Very poorly drained water is removed from the soil so slowly that the watertable remains at or near the surface for most of the year. Surface flow, groundwater and subsurface flow are major sources of water, although precipitation may be important where there is a perched watertable and precipitation exceeds evapotranspiration. Soils have a wide range in texture and depth, and often occur in
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 202 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Soil Profile
203
depressed sites. Strong gleying and accumulation of surface organic matter are usually features of most soils.
2 Poorly drained water is removed very slowly in relation to supply. Subsurface and/or groundwater flow, as well as precipitation, may be a significant water source. Seasonal ponding, resulting from runon and insufficient outfall, also occurs. A perched watertable may be present. Soils have a wide range in texture and depth; many have horizons that are gleyed, mottled, or possess orange or rusty linings of root channels. All horizons remain wet for several months.
3 Imperfectly drained water is removed only slowly in relation to supply. Precipitation is the main source if available water storage capacity is high, but subsurface flow and/or groundwater contribute as available water storage capacity decreases. Soils have a wide range in texture and depth. Some horizons may be mottled and/or have orange or rusty linings of root channels, and are wet for several weeks.
4 Moderately water is removed from the soil somewhat well-drained slowly in relation to supply, due to low
permeability, shallow watertable, lack of gradient, or some combination of these. Soils are usually medium to fine in texture. Significant additions of water by subsurface flow are necessary in coarse-textured soils. Some horizons may remain wet for as long as one week after water addition.
5 Well-drained water is removed from the soil readily but not rapidly. Excess water flows downward
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 203 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
204
readily into underlying, moderately permeable material or laterally as subsurface flow. The soils are often medium in texture. Some horizons may remain wet for several days after water addition.
6 Rapidly drained water is removed from the soil rapidly in relation to supply. Excess water flows downward rapidly if underlying material is highly permeable. There may be rapid subsurface lateral flow during heavy rainfall provided there is a steep gradient. Soils are usually coarse-textured, or shallow, or both. No horizon is normally wet for more than several hours after water addition.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 204 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
205
SUBSTRATEJ.G. Speight and R.F. Isbell
This chapter deals with materials and masses of earth (see pages 211 and 216) or rock that do not show pedological development. They are not soils, but typically underlie them. The substrate includes the R horizon and that part of the C horizon that shows no pedological development (page 151), but excludes the solum, buried soil horizons (including D horizons), and pans. The substrate beneath a soil profile may or may not be the parent material of the soil.
The properties of the substrate should be described as objectively as possible. The first group of properties refers to the material or substance in an intact state, as would be seen in a hand-sized specimen without cracks. Such properties serve to identify the type of rock, such as sandstone, or unconsolidated material, such as clay. A second group of properties comprising spacing of discontinuities, alteration and mass strength refers to substrate masses. These require observations of areas of greater dimensions. Types of substrate mass are classified mainly according to their inferred origin. Examples are alluvium, parna, ferricrete and saprolite.
The substrate should be assessed at the point of the soil profile observation or as close to it as may be practicable. Large vertical exposures of the substrate may reveal the spatial variation of substrate features.
Type of observation of substrate materialP Soil pitE Existing vertical exposure
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 205 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
206
C Undisturbed soil coreA Auger boringO Outcrop, where presumed continuous with substrate
DistanceEstimate the distance in metres of the point of observation of substrate material from the point of soil observation.
Confidence that substrate is parent materialThe observer should state the degree of confidence that the observed substrate material is the parent material of the observed soil profile or the major part of that profile (i.e. of the B horizon).
N Not parent materialD Dubious, doubtfulP ProbableA Almost certain or certain
DepthMeasure or estimate, in metres, the depth of the point of observation of substrate material below the land surface.
PROPERTIES OF SUBSTRATE MATERIALThe properties in this section refer to intact hand-sized samples or very small areas of outcrop. In many cases it will be necessary to use a ×10 hand lens to determine some of them.
Grain sizeIt is informative to estimate the size of the most common particles of a substrate material whether the material is thought to be of sedimentary, metamorphic or igneous origin.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 206 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Substrate
207
1 <0.06 mm18 silt- or clay-sized; grains not visible (e.g. chert, shale, basalt, silt, coal).
2 0.06–2 mm18 sand-sized; grains visible (e.g. sand, sandstone, dolerite, porphyry, sandy tuff, graywacke, microgranite, schist, quartzite).
3 >2 mm gravel-sized (e.g. gravel, conglomerate, breccia, pebbles, cobbles, stones, boulders, pegmatite, granite, agglomerate).
TextureF Fragmental consisting of mineral or rock particles that are
broken or abraded.
X Crystalline (non-porphyritic)
consisting of interlocking mineral crystals.
P Porphyritic crystalline, with individual larger crystals in a matrix of much smaller crystals or glass.
A Amorphous without visible crystalline or fragmental texture, even through a hand lens.
StructureV Massive no recognisable structure.
S Vesicular sponge-like structure having large pores, which may or may not be filled with softer material.
18 As shown by Figure 15, page 162, these size grade limits agree with the scale of Wentworth (1922), adopted by the United States National Research Council (Pettijohn 1957) and the American Geophysical Union (Lane et al. 1947), and with that of the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, also adopted by the British Standards Institution (1975) and the Standards Association of Australia (1977). The 0.06 mm boundary criterion (strictly 0.063 mm) separating sand and silt differs markedly from the value 0.02 mm of the International scheme (proposed originally by Atterberg, 1905, and accepted by the International Society of Soil Science); the 0.05 mm value of the United States Department of Agriculture (Soil Survey Staff 1975); and the 0.075 mm value of the Unified Soil Classification (US Army Corps of Engineers 1953).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 207 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
208
C Concretionary spheroidal concretions cemented together.
P Platy plate-like units cemented together.
R Vermicular worm-like structure and/or cavities.
B Bedded with planar surfaces marking successively deposited layers.
F Fissile easily split along closely spaced parallel planes.
L Foliated planar arrangement of textural or structural textures.
Porosity0 Non porous; dense1 Slightly porous2 Porous
Mineral compositionMake provision for recording one dominant mineral and one or two minor minerals, as identified by inspection of the hand specimen.
Q QuartzF FeldsparM MicaD Dark mineralsL Clays (argillaceous)K Carbonates (react with 1 Molar HCl)S SesquioxidesG GlauconiteC Carbonaceous materialY Gypsum
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 208 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Substrate
209
Strength of materialThe strength of a specimen of soil substrate material may be crudely estimated in the field by striking it with the head-end or the pick-end of a geological hammer or by trying to cut it with a knife, and then referring to Table 32. These estimates refer to the unconfined (or uniaxial) compressive strength. The strength is that of the intact material rather than that of the mass, the strength of which has generally been reduced by the development of fractures and other phenomena.
Lithological type of substrate materialThe properties above will key out many of the rock types and unconsolidated materials listed in Tables 33 and 34.
Record the rock type only if it is definitely known or is confidently presumed. An alphabetic checklist for types of substrate material, both rocks and unconsolidated materials, is given in Table 35. Only the more common materials are listed. Others can be recorded in free format.
Table 32 Field estimation of strength class of intact rock material by cutting or striking with knife, pick or hammera
Strength Knife Pick Hammer (single blow)
VW Very weak rock(1–25 MPa)
Deep cut Crumbles Flattened or powdered
W Weak rock(25–50 MPa)
Shallow cut or scratch
Indents deeply
Shattered into many small fragments
M Moderately strong rock(50–100 MPa)
Nil or slight mark
Indents shallowly
Breaks readily into a few large and some small fragments
S Strong rock(100–200 MPa)
Nil Nil Breaks into one or two large fragments
VS Very strong rock(>200 MPa)
Nil Nil Nil
a This table was developed through correspondence with MJ Selby (see Piteau 1971; Selby 1980; Hoek and Bray 1977, page 99; and compare with Anon. 1977).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 209 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
210
PROPERTIES OF SUBSTRATE MASSESThese properties generally require observation of a near-vertical face 1 m2 or more in area.
Spacing of discontinuitiesPhysical weathering opens up fissures or joints that reduce the strength of the rock mass relative to that of the intact rock material. These fissures generally increase in number towards the land surface. The following categories of discontinuity spacing apply (Deere 1968; Selby 1982):
S >3 m solid; virtually unjointed.M 1–3 m massive; few joints.B 300 mm – 1 m blocky; moderately jointed.F 50–300 mm fractured; intensely jointed.C <50 mm crushed or shattered.
Table 33 Unconsolidated material classificationa
Non-volcanic Volcanic
Grain size class
Diameter (mm)
Without significant carbonate
With significant carbonate
Very coarse grained
>60 BO SN CB
Boulders Stones Cobbles
BB Bombs (or blocks)
Coarse grained
2–60 GV Gravel SK Scoria (or lapilli)
Medium grained
0.06b–2 S Sand KS Calcareous sand
AS Volcanic ash (sandy)
Fine grained
0.002–0.06 Z Silt AF Volcanic ash (fine)
Very fine grained
<0.002 C Clay ML Marl
a Material that is loose, plastic, or does not exceed the strength of ‘Very weak rock’ in Table 32; can be dug with hand tools.
b See footnote 18, page 207.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 210 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Substrate
211
AlterationSubstrate materials may be so extensively altered (as in deep weathering profiles) that it may be difficult or impossible to determine their original nature. Certain constituents may be either depleted or enriched. Thus, in many laterite profiles, some horizons are ferruginised, partially ferruginised and partially kaolinised, and the pallid zone kaolinised. Silicification may also be associated with deep weathering profiles although not exclusively so; for instance, some limestones may be variably silicified. In contrast, calcification, which is widespread in parts of southern Australia, is not usually associated with deep weathering.
F Ferruginised iron enriched.L Kaolinised clay enriched, usually pale coloured (e.g. the
pallid zone of a laterite profile).S Silicified silica enriched.K Calcified calcium carbonate enriched.O Other deeply weathered but no specific nature.
In some instances more than one type of alteration may be present (e.g. the mottled zone of a laterite profile may be both ferruginised and kaolinised). Where both types of alteration occur, record both.
Mass strengthThe mass strength of bodies of earth or rock affects tree growth, land-forming processes and engineering works, but it is difficult to measure. Direct tests of mass strength are not proposed here. However, broad strength classes contribute to defining types of substrate mass.
Table 36 orders types of substrate mass in terms of their unconfined compressive strength, using the same strength classes as in Table 32. In engineering usage, masses with an unconfined compressive strength less than 1.0 MPa (or 1.25 MPa; Anon. 1977) correspond to ‘soil’ or ‘earth’. The engineering definitions of soil and rock are given by Terzaghi and Peck (1967): ‘Soil is a natural aggregate of mineral grains that can be separated by such gentle mechanical means as agitation in water. Rock, on the other hand, is a natural
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 211 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
212
Table 34 Rock type classification Developed from a classification by Dearman (Anon. 1977) and that in BW 5930 1981 (British Standards
Institution 1981).
AGGLOMERATE(grains rounded)
CONGLOMERATE(grains rounded)
QUARTZSANDSTONE(mainly quartz)
SANDSTONE
GRAYWACKE
ARKOSE(mainly feldspar)
VOLCANICBRECCIA
(grains angular)
TUFF
BRECCIA(grains angular)
HALITE(NaCl)
COAL
ANHYDRITE(CaSO4)
GYPSUM(CaSO4, 2H2O )
LIM
ES
TO
NE
(C
aCO
3)C
ALC
AR
EO
US
DO
LOM
ITE
(C
aMg
(CO
3)2)
MU
DS
TO
NE
CLAY-STONE
SILT-STONE
Genetic group
Gra
in s
ize
Sedimentary rocks
Pyroclastic (Sp) Chemical (Sc)Detrital (Sd)
Structure Bedded
Fragmental (cryptocrystalline or amorphous)Texture
Evaporite ororganic matter
Volcanic rock(juvenile)CarbonateQuartz, feldspar,
rock fragments
Very coarse(Rudaceous)
Fine(Argillaceous)
Very fine(Argillaceous)
Amorphous orcryptocrystalline
2.0 mm
0.06mm
0.002 mm
Coarse(Arenaceous)
Dominantmineral grains
CHERT, JASPER
CALCI-RUDITE
CALCI-LUTITEMARL
MUDSTONESHALE(fissile)
CALC-ARENITE
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 212 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Substrate
213
GRANITE
PEGMATITE
ADAMELLITE
GNEISS
SCHIST
PHYLLITE
SLATE(stronglyfissile)
PORPHYRY(porphyritic
texture)
QUARTZPORPHYRY(porphyritic
texture)
PYROXENITE(mainly
pyroxene)
PERIDOTITE(mainlyolivine)
APLITE
MICRO-GRANITE
MARBLE(carbonate)
QUARTZITE
GRANULITE
HORNFELS
AMPHI-BOLITE
SERPENT-INITE
GREEN-STONE
TRACHYTE ANDESITE BASALT
MICRO-DIORITE
MICRO-SYENITE
DOLERITE
RHYOLITE
MYLONITE(intenselydeformed)
Metamorphic rocks(Me)
Igneous rocks (Ig)
Mafic UltramaficFelsic
Foliated Massive
Crystalline (or amorphous)
Quartz,feldspar,
mica(Various)
Quartz,potassic and
sodic feldspar
Sodic feldspar,dark minerals(little quartz)
Potassicfeldspar,
(little quartz)
Calcicfeldspar,
dark minerals
Darkminerals
VOLCANIC GLASS
MIGMATITE SYENITE DIORITE GABBRO
GRANO-DIORITE
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 213 4/02/09 12:05:30 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
214
Table 35 Alphabetical checklist of lithological type of rock material and unconsolidated materiala
AD Adamellite (Ig) JA Jasper (Sc)AG Agglomerate (Sp) LI Limestone (Sd)AC Alcrete (bauxite) (Sc) MB Marble (Me)AM Amphibolite (Me) ML Marl (Uc)AN Andesite (Ig) ME Metamorphic rock AH Anhydrite (Sc) (unidentified)AP Aplite (Ig) MD Microdiorite (lg)AR Arkose (Sd) MG Microgranite (Ig)AF Ash (fine) (Uc) MS Microsyenite (Ig)AS Ash (sandy) (Uc) MI Migmatite (Me)BA Basalt (Ig) MU Mudstone (Sd)BB Bombs (volcanic) (Uc) MY Mylonite (Me)BR Breccia (Sd) PG Pegmatite (Ig)KA Calcarenite (Sd) PE Peridotite (Ig)KM Calcareous mudstone (Sd) PL Phonolite (Ig)KS Calcareous sand (Uc) PH Phyllite (Me)KL Calcilutite (Sd) PC Porcellanite (Sc)KR Calcirudite (Sd) PO Porphyry (Ig)KC Calcrete (Sc) PY Pyroxenite (Ig)CH Chert (Sc) QZ Quartz (Ig)C Clay (Uc) QU Quartzite (Me)CO Coal (Sc) QP Quartz porphyry (Ig)CG Conglomerate (Sd) QS Quartz sandstone (Sd)CU Consolidated rock RB Red-brown hardpan (Sc)
(unidentified) RH Rhyolite (Ig)SD Detrital sedimentary S Sand (Uc)
rock (unidentified) SA Sandstone (Sd)DI Diorite (Ig) ST Schist (Me)DR Dolerite (Ig) SK Scoria (Uc)DM Dolomite (Sd) SR Serpentinite (Ig)FC Ferricrete (Sc) SH Shale (Ig)GA Gabbro (Ig) LC Silcrete (Sc)GS Gneiss (Me) Z Silt (Sd)GN Granite (Ig) ZS Siltstone (Uc)GD Granodiorite (Ig) SL Slate (Sd)GR Granulite (Me) SY Syenite (Me)GV Gravel (Uc) TR Trachyte (Ig)GW Graywacke (Sd) TU Tuff (Ig)GE Greenstone (Me) UC UnconsolidatedGY Gypsum (Sc) material (unidentified)HA Halite (Sc) VB Volcanic breccia (Sp)HO Hornfels (Me) VG Volcanic glass (Ig)IG Igneous rock
(unidentified)a Parenthesised abbreviations indicate genetic types: Ig – igneous rocks; Me – metamorphic rocks;
Sc – sedimentary rocks, chemical or organic; Sd – sedimentary rocks, detrital; Sp – sedimentary rocks, pyroclastic; Uc – unconsolidated material.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 214 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Substrate
215
Tabl
e 36
Rel
ativ
e st
reng
th, d
ensi
ty a
nd s
eism
ic v
eloc
ity o
f dry
ear
th a
nd r
ock
mas
ses
in th
e re
golit
h an
d be
droc
k zo
nesa
Stre
ngth
cla
ss
Unc
onfi
ned
com
pres
sive
st
reng
th (
MPa
)
Bul
k de
nsit
y (M
g/m
3 )
Seis
mic
ve
loci
tyb
(m/s
)
Zon
e
Bed
rock
Reg
olit
h
0.01
1.3
240
Unc
onso
lidat
ed s
ubst
rate
mas
ses:
E
Ea
rth
or ‘s
oil’
Soil
(Sof
ter)
sap
rolit
e A
lluvi
um
Col
luvi
um
Eolia
n se
dim
ent
Bea
ch s
edim
ent
Lacu
strin
e se
dim
ent
Mar
ine
sedi
men
t Fi
ll
1.0
1.8
600
VW
V
ery
wea
k ro
ckSt
abili
sed
soil
Till
Evap
orite
s (H
arde
r) s
apro
lite
Hig
hly
wea
ther
ed r
ock
252.
115
00
Con
solid
ated
(R
hor
izon
) su
bstr
ate
mas
ses:
W
W
eak
rock
(Sof
ter)
sed
imen
tary
roc
ks
(Sof
ter)
met
amor
phic
roc
ksC
oncr
ete
Mod
erat
ely
wea
ther
ed r
ock
502.
420
00
M
Mod
erat
ely
stro
ng r
ock
(Har
der)
sed
imen
tary
roc
ks
(Sof
ter)
met
amor
phic
roc
ksSl
ight
ly w
eath
ered
roc
k
100
2.7
3000
S o
r V
S
Stro
ng o
r ve
ry s
tron
g ro
ckIg
neou
s ro
cks
(Har
der)
met
amor
phic
ro
cks
Fain
tly w
eath
ered
roc
k
300
3.0
7000
a Se
e pa
ge 2
11.
b Se
ism
ic v
eloc
ity v
alue
s gi
ven
for
wea
ker
mat
eria
ls r
efer
to th
e un
satu
rate
d st
ate.
Sat
urat
ion
with
wat
er m
ay d
oubl
e th
e ve
loci
ty.
D
ata
sour
ces:
CJ B
rayb
rook
(per
s. c
omm
.); F
J Tay
lor
(per
s. c
omm
.); D
obri
n 19
60; B
artle
tt 19
71; K
esel
197
6; P
olak
and
Pet
tifer
197
6: S
chm
idt a
nd
Pier
ce 1
976;
Hoe
k an
d B
ray
1977
; Chu
rch
1981
; Sel
by 1
980,
198
2.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 215 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
216
aggregate of minerals connected by strong and permanent cohesive forces.’ In this context, ‘soil’ and ‘earth’ are synonyms (Standards Association of Australia 1981). Since ‘soil’ takes its pedological meaning throughout this Handbook, these low-strength substrate materials and masses are referred to as ‘earth’. The grain size of earth material ranges from clay to gravel or larger fragments.
The geological distinction between sediments and sedimentary rocks occurs at about 25 MPa. This higher value is also appropriate for the minimum strength of the ‘R (rock) horizon’ in soil profile description (page 151) that cannot be dug with hand tools. Table 36 distinguishes ‘Unconsolidated substrate masses’ from ‘Consolidated (R horizon) substrate masses’ at the 25 MPa value. The table also shows corresponding values of bulk density and seismic velocity. At suitable sites, the seismic velocity of various subsurface layers can be measured using portable equipment (Williams 1988). Seismic velocity varies directly with mass strength because of a functional relation to elastic constants. Bulk density happens to vary in the same sense for most earth and rock masses. The value of any one attribute indicates the likely values of the other two.
For engineering works, the following broad generalisations can be made about the strength classes of Table 36. ‘Earth’ can be picked up and carried easily using earth-moving machines such as excavators and scrapers. When stronger materials are to be moved, the first step is to reduce their strength and density to that of ‘earth’. Such material is too weak to form roads or dams without being artificially stabilised to the status of ‘very weak rock’ by compaction or other techniques (Ingles and Metcalf 1972). ‘Very weak rock’ can be dislodged with a bulldozer blade (or hand tools, for that matter), but it is easier to move if it is first broken up by a tractor-mounted ripper (Anon. 1983). ‘Weak rock’ must be ripped before it can be removed; this can be done using tractors weighing less than 40 tonnes (gross), such as the Caterpillar D8N (Anon. 1987a) and the Komatsu D155A (Anon. 1987b). ‘Moderately strong rock’ can be ripped by the heaviest tractors, but ‘strong or very strong rock’ can be broken only with explosives.
GENETIC TYPE OF SUBSTRATE MASSESBedrock and regolith zonesThe mantle of earth and rock, including weathered rocks and sediments, altered or formed by land surface processes is called the regolith. The underlying zone of rocks formed or altered by deep-seated crustal processes is the bedrock.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 216 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Substrate
217
Regolith and bedrock are regarded here as zones characterised by different processes, rather than as classes of material. The original definition of regolith by Merrill (1897) stresses the latter view and includes only unconsolidated materials.
The depth of the regolith zone ranges from zero, where bedrock outcrops at the surface, to over 100 m in areas of deep weathering (Ollier 1984).
In areas without much sediment, the lower boundary of the regolith is the weathering front (Mabbutt 1961) where features due to weathering first appear. Where sediments are very thick, their lower layers become isolated from land surface processes by their depth and by reduced permeability due to compaction. Here the base of the regolith, which could be called a ‘lithification front’, is where most of the sediments transform to sedimentary rocks. Sedimentary rocks are often folded and faulted but, at least in Australia’s stable environment, most unconsolidated sediments remain flat-lying.
Masses within the regolith zone, in contrast with those within the bedrock zone, tend to have low density, very low strength, and little cohesion between their particles or fragments. Despite Merrill’s definition, not all materials follow this tendency. Strong and cohesive masses (e.g. ferricrete) may be characteristic of the regolith. However, some layers of sedimentary rock never become strong. Other rocks are weakened within the bedrock zone by deep-seated processes. Table 36 assigns types of substrate mass to either the regolith zone or the bedrock zone.
Scheme of classificationTable 37 presents a scheme of classification of soil substrate masses as they are found in soil and land surveys. The main classes represent rock masses not yet weathered, those now being weathered, those transported and deposited but not yet consolidated, and those hardened while still near the surface.
Named classes in this table are defined in the following glossary, ‘Glossary of substrate mass genetic types’. Since this is a genetic classification, diagnostic attributes may be hard to specify. Associated landforms should not be used as recognition criteria for observed substrate masses. They can be used to infer the nature of substrate masses that cannot be observed. In the same way, substrate observations should not be used as recognition criteria for landforms.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 217 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
218
Table 37 Genetic classification of substrate masses
1 Unweathered rocks of the bedrock zoneIG Igneous rocksPL Plutonic rocksVO Volcanic rocksME Metamorphic rocksSR Sedimentary rocksSD Detrital sedimentary rocks (including eolianite)SP Pyroclastic rocks (including ignimbrite)SC Chemical and organic sedimentary rocks
2 Weathered rocksPW Partially weathered rockSA SaproliteDR Decomposed rock
3 Sediments (unconsolidated)AL AlluviumCO ColluviumSE ScreeLD Landslide depositMD Mudflow depositCD Creep depositSH Sheet flow depositED Eolian sedimentES Eolian sandLO LoessPA ParnaGY GypsumVA Volcanic ashBE Beach sedimentLA Lacustrine sedimentMA Marine sedimentTI TillFI Fill
4 Masses hardened in the regolith
RB Red-brown hardpanFC FerricreteAC Alcrete (bauxite)LC SilcretePC PorcellaniteKC Calcrete
HA Halite (rock salt)GY GypsumEV Other evaporites
SO Stabilised soilCN ConcreteAT Other artificially hardened materials
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 218 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Substrate
219
GLOSSARY OF SUBSTRATE MASS GENETIC TYPES
Aeolianite see Eolianite.
AC Alcrete (bauxite) indurated material rich in aluminium hydroxides. Commonly consists of cemented pisoliths and usually known as bauxite.
AL Alluvium sediment mass deposited from transport by channelled stream flow or overbank stream flow.
BE Beach sediment sediment mass deposited from transport by waves or tides at the shore of a sea or lake.
KC Calcrete any cemented, terrestrial carbonate accumulation that may vary significantly in morphology and degree of cementation. Also known as carbonate pan, calcareous pan, caliche, kunkar, secondary limestone, travertine. All show slight to strong effervescence with 1 Molar HCl.
SC Chemical and sedimentary rocks in which mineral grains or organic fragments are not important constituents. The sedimentary rocks group includes coal, chert and non-fragmental
limestones as well as saline rocks (evaporites) such as halite (rock salt) and gypsum. Chemical and organic sedimentary rocks are common in the regolith zone.
CO Colluvium sediment mass deposited from transport down a slope by gravity (scree), landslide (landslide deposit), mudflow (mudflow deposit), creep (creep deposit) or sheet flow (sheet flow deposit), but not by stream flow. Compared with alluvium, colluvium lacks bedding structure; is more variable in grain size (i.e. more poorly sorted); contains much local material; and is generally much more angular. Coarse particles may have particular alignments.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 219 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
220
CN Concrete artificial conglomerate rock mass of selected size grade material that has been hardened using Portland cement or other kinds of cement. Concrete is a weak rock (about 35 MPa unconfined compressive strength) usually reinforced with steel to increase its tensile strength.
CD Creep deposit colluvium slowly displaced a short distance downslope as a result of small irregular movements, with the net movement increasing towards the land surface.
DR Decomposed rock weathered material (typically soft and clay-rich) produced by thorough decomposition of rock masses due to exposure to land surface processes, but with no transport. It generally lacks any structures that may have been present in the unweathered rock (see also Saprolite and Partially weathered rock).
SD Detrital sedimentary rocks composed of mineral grains or sedimentary rocks fragments derived from pre-existing rocks. Types
are distinguished in Table 34.
ET Eolianite consolidated sedimentary rock consisting of clastic material deposited by the wind (Bates and Jackson 1987). Includes bioclastic calcarenites.
ES Eolian sand eolian sediment of sand size, often taking the form of dunes, with characteristic bedding structures.
ED Eolian sediment sediment mass deposited from transport by the wind.
EV Evaporite weak sedimentary rock or sediment formed by the precipitation of solutes from water bodies on the land surface, typically as lacustrine sediments. Includes halite and gypsum.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 220 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Substrate
221
FC Ferricrete indurated material rich in hydrated oxides of iron (usually goethite and hematite) occurring as cemented nodules and/or concretions, or as massive sheets. This material has been commonly referred to in local usage around Australia as laterite, duricrust or ironstone.
FI Fill mass of artificial sediment formed by earth-moving works. Fill is sometimes compacted to the status of a very weak rock mass (stabilised soil), but typically remains an earth mass (Table 36). Garbage forms a very low-density, low-strength fill.
GY Gypsum evaporite consisting of hydrated calcium sulfate. Non-hydrated calcium sulfate forms closely related masses called anhydrite. It may subsequently be transported by wind as fine crystals and form lunettes or more widespread sedimentary layers blanketing the landscape.
HA Halite (rock salt) evaporite consisting of sodium chloride.
IG Igneous rocks strong or very strong rock masses formed by solidification of molten rock matter (magma) derived from below the Earth’s surface. The rocks are mainly composed of interlocking crystals. Types are distinguished in Table 34. Plutonic rocks and volcanic rocks are included.
IN Ignimbrite very weak to strong volcanic rock mass deposited from a flow of ash, the stronger forms being welded together by residual heat during deposition.
LA Lacustrine sediment mass deposited from transport by waves sediment and from sediment solution and suspension in
still water in a closed depression on land.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 221 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
222
LD Landslide deposit colluvium rapidly displaced many metres downslope by failure of a mass of earth or rock. If the mass is not already a part of the regolith, the landslide incorporates it in the regolith. Original rock structures are fragmented and disorganised by the action of the landslide.
LO Loess eolian sediment of silt size.
MA Marine sediment sediment mass deposited from transport by waves and from solution and suspension in sea water.
ME Metamorphic rocks moderately strong to very strong rock masses formed by the chemical and physical alterations of igneous or sedimentary rocks under high temperatures and/or very high pressures within the Earth’s crust. Types are distinguished in Table 34.
MD Mudflow deposit colluvium mixed with water to form dense fluid, and rapidly displaced metres or kilometres downslope. The material is more thoroughly disaggregated than that of a landslide deposit and lacks the bedding and sorting of grain sizes seen in alluvium.
PA Parna fine-grained calcareous eolian sediment consisting of 30–70% clay.
PW Partially weathered material produced by exposure of rock weathered rock masses to land surface processes but with no
transport. Partial decomposition results in changes in colour, texture, composition, strength or form of the parent rock mass (see also Decomposed rock and Saprolite).
PL Plutonic rocks igneous rocks solidified at depth within the Earth’s crust.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 222 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Substrate
223
PC Porcellanite dense argillaceous rock of varying degree of silicification with a conchoidal fracture and general appearance of unglazed porcelain.
SP Pyroclastic rocks sedimentary rocks resulting from the deposition of airborne materials produced by volcanic eruptions.
RB Red-brown an informal name used for a particular indurated hardpan earthy material (see ‘Pans’, page 193). Often it is
not known if the red-brown hardpan is a paleosol or a cemented sediment (see Wright 1983).
SA Saprolite a particular form of decomposed rock. It is characterised by the preservation of structures (including ‘texture’ in the petrological sense) that were present in the unweathered rock.
SE Scree colluvium deposited after falling or rolling from cliffed or steep slopes, consisting of loose rock fragments of gravel size or larger and generally lacking a fine interstitial component.
SR Sedimentary rocks weak or moderately strong rock masses formed by the hardening of sediments due to compaction, recrystallisation or cementation. These processes can occur within the regolith but are promoted by burial within the Earth’s crust. Major categories of sedimentary rocks are detrital sedimentary rocks, pyroclastic rocks, and chemical and organic sedimentary rocks.
SH Sheet flow deposit colluvium deposited from transport by a very shallow flow of water as a sheet, or network of rills on the land surface. Sheet flow deposits are very thin except at the foot of a slope and beneath sheet-flood fans.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 223 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
224
LC Silcrete strongly indurated siliceous material cemented by, and largely composed of, forms of silica, including quartz, chalcedony, opal and chert.
ST Stabilised soil artificial mass with the strength grade of very weak rock. It results from the ‘stabilisation’ of an earth mass by a variety of processes: compaction; the admixture of lime, Portland cement, bitumen or other substances; heating; freezing; or electro-hardening. Cement stabilisation can produce a mass as strong as 10 MPa unconfined compressive strength (Ingles and Metcalf 1972).
TI Till sediment mass deposited from transport in ice, as in a glacier. Till is neither bedded nor sorted; it has a matrix of clay or silt enclosing larger particles of unweathered rock ranging up to large boulders.
VA Volcanic ash eolian sediment consisting of relatively fine (<2 mm) pyroclastic material. It often contains a proportion of highly weatherable glass.
VO Volcanic rocks igneous rocks solidified after eruption on to the land surface.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 224 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
225
APPENDIX 1: SOIL TAXONOMIC U NITS
R.F. Isbell and R.C. McDonald
This appendix gives coding of soil taxonomic units in soil classification schemes most likely to be used in Australian soil and land surveys. Classification schemes appropriate to the particular survey purpose will be chosen by each survey organisation or individual.
THE AUSTRALIAN SOIL CLASSIFICATIONThe Australian Soil Classification (Isbell 1996) is recommended for use in Australian soil and land surveys. A complete class list and codes are given in this publication. Concepts and rationale of the Australian soil classification (Isbell et al. 1997) is designed to be read in conjunction with the classification and gives the rationale for the establishment of various classes and diagnostic criteria.
Codes for the 14 Orders are listed below.
Anthroposols AN Kurosols KU
Calcarosols CA Organosols OR
Chromosols CH Podosols PO
Dermosols DE Rudosols RU
Ferrosols FE Tenosols TE
Hydrosols HY Sodosols SO
Kandosols KA Vertosols VE
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 225 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
226
If the Order is indeterminable from the available information, the code should be YY.
SOIL TAXONOMYCodes for the 11 orders of Soil Taxonomy (Soil Survey Staff 1996) are listed below.
Alfisols A Inceptisols I
Andisols C Mollisols M
Aridisols D Oxisols O
Entisols E Spodosols S
Histosols H Ultisols U
Vertisols V
WORLD REFERENCE BASE FOR SOIL RESOURCES (WRB)This classification system (IUSS Working Group WRB 2006) is the framework for international classification, correlation and communication. The WRB does not replace national soil classification systems and is a tool for correlation between national systems. Codes for the 32 reference soil groups of the WRB are listed below.
Acrisols AC Kastanozems KS
Albeluvisols AB Leptosols LP
Alisols AL Lixisols LX
Andosols AN Luvisols LV
Anthrosols AT Nitisols NT
Arenosols AR Phaeozems PH
Calcisols CL Planosols PL
Cambisols CM Plinthosols PT
Chernozems CH Podzols PZ
Cryosols CR Regosols RG
Durisols DU Solonchaks SC
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 226 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Appendix 1
227
Ferralsols FR Solonetz SN
Fluvisols FL Stagnosols ST
Gleysols GL Technosols TE
Gypsisols GY Umbrisols UM
Histosols HS Vertisols VR
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 227 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 228 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
229
REFERENCES
Abed T, Stephens NC (2003) ‘Tree measurement manual for farm foresters: practical guidelines for farm foresters undertaking basic tree measure-ment in farm forest plantations (2nd edn).’ (Ed. M Parsons) National Forest Inventory, Bureau of Rural Sciences, Canberra, <http://affashop.gov.au/product.asp?prodid=12760>, [confirmed 9 March 2008].
Anderson JR (1999) ‘Basic decision support system for management of urban streams. Report No. 1: Development of the classification system for urban streams.’ LWRRDC Occasional Paper 8/99, <http://www.precisioninfo.com/rivers_org/au/library/nrhp/decn_supp_syst/>, [confirmed 9 March 2008].
Anon. (1977) The description of rock masses for engineering purposes: report by the Geological Society Engineering Group Working Party. Quarterly Journal of Engineering Geology and Hydrogeology 10, 355–388.
Anon. (1979) ‘Pedon coding system for the national co-operative soil survey.’ USDA Soil Conservation Service, July 1979.
Anon. (1983) ‘Handbook of ripping (7th edn).’ (Caterpillar Tractor: Peoria, Illi-nois, USA).
Anon. (1987a) ‘Caterpillar performance handbook (18th edn).’ (Caterpillar: Peoria, Illinois, USA).
Anon. (1987b) ‘Specifications and application handbook (10th edn).’ (Komatsu: Tokyo).
Anon. (1994) ‘The Ramsar Convention on Wetlands.’ 1971, amended 1982 and 1987, published 1994, posted on web 1996 at <http://www.ramsar.org/key_conv_e.htm>, [confirmed 9 March 2008].
Atterberg A (1905) Die rationelle Klassifikation der Sande und Kiese. Chemiker Zeitung 29, 195–198.
Australia’s Virtual Herbarium (2007), Centre for Plant Biodiversity Research <http://www.anbg.gov.au/avh/>, [confirmed 9 March 2008].
Avery BW (1980) ‘Soil classification for England and Wales.’ Soil Survey Tech-nical Monograph No. 14 (Soil Survey of England and Wales: Harpenden, Herts, UK).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 229 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
230
Bartlett AH (1971) Geophysical aspects of engineering investigations. ANZAAS Engineering Geology Symposium, Brisbane (mimeo).
Bates RL, Jackson JA (1987) (Eds) ‘Glossary of geology (3rd edn).’ (American Geological Institute: Alexandria, Virginia, USA).
Bleeker P, Speight, JG (1978) Soil–landform relationships at two localities in Papua New Guinea. Geoderma 21, 183–198.
Bonell M, Gilmour DA, Cassells DS (1983) A preliminary survey of the hydrau-lic properties of rainforest soils in tropical north-east Queensland and their implications for the runoff process. In ‘Rainfall simulation, runoff and soil erosion.’ (Ed. J De Ploey) Catena Supplement No. 4, 57–78.
Brack C (1998) <http://sres.anu.edu.au/associated/mensuration/Brackand-Wood1998/TOOLS.HTM> (accessed 24/02/2005), [confirmed 9 March 2008]. Includes internal links to individual instruments, methods of use and comparisons of performance.
Brewer R (1960) Cutans: their definition, recognition and classification. Euro-pean Journal of Soil Science 11, 280–292.
Brewer R (1964) ‘Fabric and mineral analysis of soils.’ (John Wiley and Sons, New York).
British Standards Institution (1975) ‘Methods of tests of soils for civil engineer-ing purposes.’ BS 1377 Gr 10.
British Standards Institution (1981) ‘Code of practice for site investigations.’ BS 5930: 1981 (British Standards Institution: London).
Brock MA, Casanova MT (2000) ‘Are there plants in your wetland? Revegetat-ing wetlands.’ Land and Water Resources Research and Development Corporation, University of New England, Department of Land and Water Conservation, and Environment Australia, <http://www.lwa.gov.au/downloads/publications_pdf/PF000026.pdf> (accessed 12/4/2005), [confirmed 9 March 2008].
BRS (Bureau of Rural Sciences) (2007) ‘Revegetation monitoring and reporting in Australia.’ BRS Canberra, <http://affashop.gov.au/product.asp?prodid =13827>
Butler BE (1955) A system for the description of soil structure and consistence in the field. Journal of the Australian Institute of Agricultural Science 21, 239–249.
Canada Soil Survey Committee (1978) ‘The Canada Soil Information System (Can SIS): manual for describing soils in the field.’ (Land Resource Research Institute: Ottawa, Ontario, Canada).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 230 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
References
231
Carnahan JA (1977) Natural vegetation. In ‘Atlas of Australian resources, second series.’ (Department of Natural Resources: Canberra).
Cayley A (1859) On contour and slope lines. The London, Edinburgh and Dublin Philosophical Magazine and Journal of Science, 4th series, 18, 264–268.
Chamberlin TC, Salisbury RD (1904) ‘Geology: volume 1 – geologic processes and their results.’ (Henry Holt and Company: New York).
Charman PEV (1978) ‘Soils of New South Wales: their characterization, classi-fication and conservation.’ Soil Conservation Service NSW Technical Handbook No. 1.
Chittleborough DJ (1978) Soil variability within land systems and land units at Monarto, South Australia. Australian Journal of Soil Research 16, 137–155.
Church HK (1981) ‘Excavation handbook.’ (McGraw-Hill: New York).Commonwealth of Australia (2001) ‘A directory of important wetlands in
Australia (3rd edn).’ Environment Australia, Canberra.Commonwealth of Australia (2007) ‘Flora of Australia Online.’ <http://www.
environment.gov.au/biodiversity/abrs/online-resources/flora/main/> (accessed 8/2007) [confirmed 9 March 2008].
Crouch RJ (1976) Field tunnel erosion: a review. Journal of the Soil Conservation Service of NSW 32, 98–111.
Davis WM (1889) Topographic development of the Triassic formation of the Connecticut Valley. American Journal of Science, 3rd series, 37, 430.
Deere DV (1968) Geological considerations. In ‘Rock mechanics in engineering practice.’ (Eds OC Zienkiewicz and D Stagg) (Wiley: New York) pp. 1–20.
Dobrin MB (1960) ‘Introduction to geophysical prospecting (2nd edn).’ (McGraw-Hill: New York).
ESCAVI (Executive Steering Committee for Australian Vegetation Informa-tion) (2003) ‘Australian vegetation attribute manual, version 6.0.’ Depart-ment of Environment and Heritage, Canberra, <http://www.deh.gov.au/erin/nvis/avam/> [confirmed 9 March 2008].
Eyre TJ, Kelly AL, Neldner VJ (2006) ‘BioCondition: a terrestrial vegetation condition assessment tool for biodiversity in Queensland: field assess-ment manual, version 1.5.’ Environmental Protection Agency, Brisbane, <http://www.epa.qld.gov.au/publications/?id=1927> [confirmed 9 March 2008].
Eyre TJ, Kelly AL, Sutcliffe T, Ward D, Denham R, Jermyn D, Venz M (2002) ‘Forest condition assessment and implications for biodiversity: final
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 231 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
232
report.’ Queensland Department of Natural Resources, <http://pandora.nla.gov.au/pan/26050/20020805/www.ea.gov.au/land/nlwra/condi-tion/brigalow/index.html> (accessed 24/5/2005) [confirmed 9 March 2008].
FAO (1968) ‘Guidelines for soil profile description.’ (Soil Survey and Fertility Branch, Land and Water Division, Food and Agriculture Organization of the United Nations: Rome, Italy).
Gunn RH, Beattie JA, Reid RE, van de Graaff RHM (1988) (Eds) ‘Australian soil and land survey handbook: guidelines for conducting surveys.’ (Inkata Press: Melbourne).
Hnatiuk RJ, Thackway R, Walker J (2008) ‘Field survey for vegetation classifi-cation.’ Bureau of Rural Sciences Version 1, <http://www.affashop.gov.au/product.asp?prodid=13881>
Hnatiuk RJ, Thackway R, Walker J (2009) ‘Vegetation.’ Online version of Chap-ter 6 with links to additional information, <http://www.publish.csiro.au/nid/22/pid/5230.htm>
Hodgson JM (1974) (Ed.) ‘Soil survey field handbook: describing and sampling soil profiles.’ Soil Survey Technical Monograph No. 5 (Soil Survey of England and Wales, Rothamsted Experimental Station: Harpenden, Herts, UK).
Hoek E, Bray J (1977) ‘Rock slope engineering (2nd edn).’ (The Institution of Mining and Metallurgy: London).
Holm AMcR, Burnside DG, Mitchell AA (1987) The development of a system for monitoring trend in range condition in the arid shrublands of West-ern Australia. The Rangeland Journal 9, 14–20.
Horton RE (1945) Erosional development of streams and their drainage basins: hydrophysical approach to quantitative morphology. Bulletin of the Geological Society of America 56, 275–370.
Houghton PD, Charman PEV (1986) ‘Glossary of terms used in soil conserva-tion.’ (Soil Conservation Service of NSW: Sydney).
Hunt CB (1972) ‘Geology of soils: their evolution, classification, and uses.’ (WH Freeman and Company: San Francisco).
Ingles OG, Metcalf JB (1972) ‘Soil stabilization: principles and practice.’ (Butter-worths: Sydney).
Intergovernmental Committee on Surveying and Mapping (2002) ‘Geocentric datum of Australia technical manual’, version 2.2.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 232 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
References
233
International Society of Soil Science (1967) Proposal for a uniform system of soil horizon designations. Bulletin of the International Society of Soil Science 31, 4–7.
Isbell RF (1996) ‘The Australian soil classification.’ (CSIRO Publishing: Melbourne).
Isbell RF, McDonald WS, Ashton LJ (1997) ‘Concepts and rationale of the Australian soil classification.’ (ACLEP, CSIRO Land and Water: Canberra).
IUSS Working Group WRB (2006) ‘World reference base for soil resources 2006.’ World Soils Reports No. 103. (FAO: Rome).
Jacobs MR (1955) ‘Growth habits of the eucalypts.’ Canberra, Forestry and Timber Bureau, Department of the Interior, Commonwealth Government Printer, Canberra.
Jarman SJ, Kantvilas G, Brown MJ (1991) ‘Floristic and ecological studies in Tasmanian rainforest.’ Tasmanian National Rainforest Conservation Program (NRCP) Australia, report no. 3.
Kesel RH (1976) The use of refraction-seismic techniques in geomorphology. Catena 3, 91–98.
King LC (1953) Canons of landscape evolution. Bulletin of the Geological Society of America 64, 721–752.
King PM (1981) Comparison of methods for measuring severity of water-repel-lency of sandy soils and assessment of some factors that affect its meas-urement. Australian Journal of Soil Research 19, 275–285.
Lane EW, Brown C, Gibson GC, Howard CS, Krumbein WC, Matthes GH, Rubey WW, Trowbridge AC, Straub LG (1947) Report of the subcommit-tee on sediment terminology. Transactions of the American Geophysical Union 28, 936–938.
Lange RT, Purdie R (1976) ‘Western myall (Acacia sowdenii), its survival pros-pects and management needs.’ Australian Rangelands Journal 1, 64–69. Ex Lange RT, Sparrow AD (1992) ‘Growth rates of western myall (Acacia papyrocarpa Benth.) during its main phase of canopy spreading.’ Austral-ian Journal of Ecology 17, 315–320.
Lange RT, Sparrow AD (1992) Growth rates of western myall (Acacia papyro-carpa Benth.) during its main phase of canopy spreading. Australian Jour-nal of Ecology 17, 315–320.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 233 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
234
Lawrie JW (1978) Hardpans in western New South Wales. In ‘Proceedings of the International Rangeland Congress.’ pp. 303–306 (International Range-land Congress: Denver, Colorado, USA).
Löffler E (1974) Geomorphology of Papua New Guinea (map). CSIRO Aust. Land Research Series No. 33.
Löffler E, Ruxton BP (1969) Relief and landform map of Australia. In ‘The representative basin concept in Australia.’ Australian Water Resources Council, Hydrological Series No. 2.
Lynch DL, Kolenbrander LG (1981) ‘A method of evaluating landform classifi-cation systems for renewable resource assessment and planning.’ Land-form Classification Final Report 16-925-CA, Rocky Mountain Forest and Range Experiment Station, US Forest Service.
Ma’shum M, Tate ME, Jones GP, Oades JM (1988) Extraction and characterisa-tion of water-repellent materials from Australian soils. European Journal of Soil Science 39, 99–110.
Mabbutt JA (1961) ‘Basal surface’ or ‘Weathering front’. Proceedings of the Geolo-gists’ Association, London 72, 357–358.
Macvicar CN (1969) A basis for the classification of soil. European Journal of Soil Science 20, 141–152.
Mark DM (1974) Line intersection method for estimating drainage density. Geology 2, 235–236.
Marshall TJ (1947) ‘Mechanical composition of soil in relation to field descrip-tions of texture.’ CSIR Aust. Bull. No. 224.
McCarthy MA, Parris KM, Ree van der R, McDonnell MJ, Burgman MA, Williams NSG, McLean N, Harper MJ, Meyer R, Hahs A, Coates T (2003) The habitat hectares approach to vegetation assessment: an evaluation and suggestions for improvement. Ecological Management and Restoration 5, 24.
McCoy RM (1971) Rapid measurement of drainage density. Bulletin of the Geological Society of America 82, 757–762.
McDonald RC (1977) ‘Soil horizon nomenclature.’ Qld Dept. Prim. Ind. Agric. Chem. Branch Tech. Mem. 1/77.
McDonald RC, Isbell RF (1990) Location. In ‘Australian soil and land survey handbook: field handbook (2nd edn).’ (Eds RC McDonald, RF Isbell, JG Speight, J Walker and MS Hopkins) (Inkata Press: Melbourne) pp. 5–7.
McElroy CT (1952) Contour trench formations in upland plains of New South Wales. Journal and Proceedings of the Royal Society of N.S.W. 85, 53–63.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 234 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
References
235
McGhie DA, Posner AM (1980) Water-repellence of a heavy textured Western Australian surface soil. Australian Journal of Soil Research 18, 309–323.
McKeague JA, Wang C, Topp GC (1982) Estimating saturated hydraulic conduc-tivity from soil morphology. Soil Science Society of America Journal 46, 1239–1244.
McKenzie NJ, Grundy MJ, Webster R, Ringrose-Voase AJ (2008) ‘Guidelines for surveying soil and land resources (2nd edn).’ (CSIRO Publishing: Melbourne).
McNaught L, Thackway R, Brown L, Parsons M (2006) ‘A field manual for surveying and mapping nationally significant weeds.’ Bureau of Rural Sciences, Canberra.
Melton FA (1936) An empirical classification of flood-plain streams. Geographi-cal Review 26, 593–609.
Merrill GP (1897) ‘A treatise on rocks: rock-weathering and soils.’ (Macmillan: New York).
Moore ID, O’Loughlin EM, Burch GJ (1988) A contour based topographic model for hydrological and ecological applications. Earth Surface Proc-esses and Landforms 13, 305–320.
Morse RJ, Craze B, Atkinson G, Crichton JR, Ryan PT, Koppi AJ, Abraham NA, Murphy BW (1987) ‘New South Wales soil data system handbook (draft edn).’ (Soil Conservation Service of NSW: Sydney).
Mueller-Dombois D, Ellenberg H (1974) ‘Aims and methods of vegetation ecol-ogy.’ (John Wiley and Sons: New York).
Munsell Soil Color Charts (Munsell Color Co. Inc. Baltimore 18, Maryland 21218, USA).
National Land and Water Resources Audit (2001) ‘Rangelands – Tracking Changes – Australian Collaborative Rangeland Information System <http://audit.ea.gov.au/anra/rangelands/docs/tracking_changes/Track_change_contents.html> (redirected to <http://www.anra.gov.au/index.html> [confirmed 9 March 2008].
National Mapping Council of Australia (1986) ‘The Australian geodetic datum technical manual.’ Special Publication No. 10 (Australian Government Publishing Service: Canberra).
Northcote KH (1971) ‘A factual key for the recognition of Australian soils (3rd edn).’ (Rellim Tech. Pubs: Glenside, SA).
Northcote KH (1979) ‘A factual key for the recognition of Australian soils (4th edn).’ (Rellim Tech. Pubs: Glenside, SA).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 235 4/02/09 12:05:31 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
236
Northcote KH, Hubble GD, Isbell RF, Thompson CH, Bettenay E (1975) ‘A description of Australian soils.’ (CSIRO Aust.: Melbourne).
Ollier C (1984) ‘Weathering (2nd edn).’ (Oliver and Boyd: Edinburgh).Olson GW (1973) ‘Soil survey interpretation for engineering purposes.’ FAO
Soils Bull. No. 19.Oyama M, Takehara H (1970) ‘Revised standard soil color charts.’ (Frank
McCarthy Color, 38 Marshall Ave, Kew, Victoria, Australia).Parkes D, Newell G, Cheal D (2003) Assessing the quality of native vegetation:
the ‘habitat hectares’ approach. Ecological Management and Restoration 4, s29–s38.
Parkes D, Newell G, Cheal D (2004) The development and raison d’etre of ‘habi-tat hectares’: a response to McCarthy et al. Ecological Management and Restoration 5, 28–29.
Payne AL, Van Vreeswyk AME, Pringle HJR, Leighton KA, Hennig P (1998) ‘An inventory and condition survey of the Sandstone–Yalgoo–Paynes Find area, Western Australia.’ Technical Bulletin no. 90, Agriculture Western Australia, South Perth.
PCA (1962) ‘PCA soil primer.’ (Portland Cement Association, Old Orchard Road, Skokie, Illinois, USA).
Penridge LK, Walker J (1988) The crown-gap ratio (C) and crown cover: deriva-tion and simulation study. Australian Journal of Ecology 13, 109–120.
Pettijohn FJ (1957) ‘Sedimentary rocks (2nd edn).’ (Harper: New York).Piteau DR (1971) Geological factors significant to the stability of slopes cut in
rock. In ‘Planning open pit mines.’ (Ed. PWJ van Rensburg) (AA Balkema: Amsterdam).
Polak EJ, Pettifer GR (1976) ‘The use of surface geophysical methods in under-ground water investigations.’ Bur. Min. Res. Geol. Geophys. Australia, Record 1976/108.
Raunkiaer C (1934) ‘The life forms of plants and statistical plant geography.’ (Oxford University Press: Oxford).
Raupach M, Tucker BM (1959) The field determination of soil reaction. Journal of the Australian Institute of Agricultural Science 25, 129–133.
Reid JB, Hill RS, Brown MJ, Hovenden MJ (1999) (Eds) ‘Vegetation of Tasmania.’ Flora of Australia Supplementary Series Number 8, University of Tasma-nia, Forestry Tasmania, CRC for Sustainable Production Forestry, Hobart.
Schmidt PW, Pierce KL (1976) Mapping of mountain soils west of Denver, Colorado, for landuse planning. In ‘Geomorphology and engineering.’
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 236 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
References
237
(Ed. DR Coates) (Dowden, Hutchinson and Ross: Stroudsburg, Pennsyl-vania) pp. 43–54.
Selby MJ (1980) A rock mass strength classification for geomorphic purposes: with tests from Antarctica and New Zealand. Zeitschrift für Geomorpholo-gie 24, 31–51.
Selby MJ (1982) ‘Hillslope materials and processes.’ (Oxford University Press: Oxford).
Smith GD, Arya LM, Stark J (1975) The densipan, a diagnostic horizon of densiaquults for soil taxonomy. Soil Science Society of America Proceedings 39, 369–370.
Smyth A, James C, Whiteman G (2003) (Eds) ‘Expert technical workshop: biodiversity monitoring in the Rangelands: a way forward.’ Report to Environment Australia, vol. 1, Centre for Arid Zone Research, CSIRO Sustainable Ecosystems, Alice Springs.
Soil Survey Staff (1951) ‘Soil survey manual.’ USDA Agricultural Handbook No. 18 (Government Printer: Washington, DC).
Soil Survey Staff (1975) ‘Soil Taxonomy: a basic system of soil classification for making and interpreting soil surveys.’ USDA Agricultural Handbook No. 436 (Government Printer: Washington, DC).
Soil Survey Staff (1990) ‘Keys to Soil Taxonomy (4th edn).’ SMSS Technical Monograph No. 6 (Virginia Polytechnic and State University: Blacksburg, Virginia).
Soil Survey Staff (1996) ‘Keys to Soil Taxonomy (7th edn).’ (Pocahontas Press: Blacksburg, Virginia).
Specht RL, Roe EM, Boughton VH (1974) (Eds) Conservation of major plant communities in Australia and Papua New Guinea. Australian Journal of Botany Supplement No. 7.
Speight JG (1967) Appendix 1: explanation of land system descriptions. In ‘Lands of Bougainville and Buka Islands, Territory of Papua and New Guinea.’ (RM Scott, PB Heyligers, JR McAlpine, JC Saunders, and JG Spei-ght.) CSIRO Aust. Land Res. Ser. No. 20, 174–184.
Speight JG (1971) Log–normality of slope distributions. Zeitschrift für Geomor-phologie 15, 290–311.
Speight JG (1974) ‘A parametric approach to landform regions.’ Inst. Brit. Geog-raphy Special Publication No. 7, 213–230.
Speight JG (1976) Numerical classification of landform elements from air photo data. Zeitschrift für Geomorphologie Suppl. 25, 154–168.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 237 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
238
Speight JG (1977) Landform pattern descriptions from aerial photographs. Photogrammetria 32, 161–182.
Speight JG (1980) The role of topography in controlling through-flow genera-tion: a discussion. Earth Surface Processes and Landforms 5, 187–191.
Stace HCT, Hubble GD, Brewer R, Northcote KH, Sleeman JR, Mulcahy MJ, Hallsworth EG (1968) ‘A handbook of Australian soils.’ (Rellim Tech. Pubs: Glenside, SA).
Standards Association of Australia (1977) ‘Australian standard 1289: methods of testing soils for engineering purposes.’ (Standards Association of Australia, Standards House, 80 Arthur Street, North Sydney, NSW).
Standards Association of Australia (1981) ‘Site investigations, known as the SAA Site Investigation Code, AS 1726–1981.’ (Standards Association of Australia, Standards House, 80 Arthur Street, North Sydney, NSW).
Talsma T (1983) Soils of the Cotter catchment area, ACT: distribution, chemical and physical properties. Australian Journal of Soil Research 21, 241–255.
Terzaghi K, Peck RB (1967) ‘Soil mechanics in engineering practice (2nd edn).’ (Wiley: New York).
Thackway R, Lesslie R (2005) Vegetation assets, states and transitions (VAST): accounting for vegetation condition in the Australian landscape. BRS Technical Report, Bureau of Rural Sciences, Canberra, <http://www.daff.gov.au/__data/assets/pdf_file/0007/96982/vast_report.pdf> [confirmed 9 March 2008].
Thackway R, Lesslie R (2006) Reporting vegetation condition using the Vege-tation Assets, States, and Transitions (VAST) framework. Ecological Management and Restoration 7(s1), s53–s62.
Thackway R, Neldner VJ, Bolton MP (2008) Vegetation. In ‘Guidelines for survey-ing soil and land resources (2nd edn).’ (Eds NJ McKenzie, MJ Grundy, R Webster and AJ Ringrose-Voase) (CSIRO Publishing: Melbourne).
Thackway R, Sonntag S, Keenan R (2006) ‘Measuring ecosystem health and natural resource productivity: vegetation condition as an indicator of sustainable, productive ecosystems.’ (Science for Decision Makers, Bureau of Rural Sciences: Canberra, ACT).
US Army Corps of Engineers (1953) ‘Unified soil classification system.’ US Army Corps of Engineers Waterways Experiment Station, Technical Manual 3–357, Vicksburg, Mississippi, USA.
Walker J, Crapper PF, Penridge LK (1988) The crown-gap ratio (C) and crown cover: the field study. Australian Journal of Ecology 13, 101–108.
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 238 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
References
239
Walker J, Hopkins MS (1990) Vegetation. In ‘Australian soil and land survey handbook: field handbook (2nd edn).’ (Eds RC McDonald, RF Isbell, JG Speight, J Walker and MS Hopkins) (Inkata Press: Melbourne) pp. 58–86.
Warren JF (1965) The scalds of western New South Wales – a form of water erosion. Australian Geographer 9, 282–292.
Webb LJ (1959) A physiognomic classification of Australian rainforests. Journal of Ecology 47, 551–570.
Webb LJ, Tracey JG, Williams WT (1976) The value of structural features in tropical forest typology. Australian Journal of Ecology 1, 3–28.
Wentworth CK (1922) A scale of grade and class terms for clastic sediments. Journal of Geology 30, 377–392.
Wetherby K (1984) ‘The extent and significance of water repellent sands of Eyre Peninsula.’ Tech. Report 47, South Australian Department of Agriculture.
Williams BG (1988) Subsurface investigations. In ‘Australian soil and land survey handbook: guidelines for conducting surveys.’ (Eds RH Gunn, JA Beattie, RE Reid and RHM van de Graaff) (Inkata Press: Melbourne) pp. 154–165.
Williams J (1983) Soil hydrology. In ‘Soils: an Australian viewpoint.’ Division of Soils, CSIRO (CSIRO: Melbourne/Academic Press: London) pp. 507–530.
Wright MJ (1983) Red-brown hardpans and associated soils in Australia. Trans-actions of the Royal Society of South Australia 107, 252–254.
Young A (1972) ‘Slopes.’ (Oliver and Boyd: Essex).
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 239 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
240
INDEX
Where more than one page reference is given, the numbers in bold type indicate reference to definitions or principal discussion.
accordance, surfaces of 45aggradation 29, 138
sampling area for 5site dimension for 5
air photo reference 10–1alcove 32alcrete (bauxite) 194, 219algae
fresh or brackish 88marine 88
alluvial fan 58alluvial plain 59alluvium 219altan units 19alteration of substrate
material 211anastomotic plain 59, 61angular blocky
structure 173, 176anti-gradational activity 29apedal 171–2aquatic higher plants 88artificial levee 40aspect 127
sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5
attributes 1, 2of landform
elements 17–8of landform pattern 44–5soil and site 3
Australian Map Grid 8
backplain 32badlands 61bank 32
bar 32bar plain 61barchan dune 32bare surface 88bauxite (alcrete) 194, 219beach 32beach ridge 33beach ridge plain 61beach sediment 219bed, see stream bedbedrock 216bench 33berm 33bidirectional channel
network 52bleach
conspicuous 152sporadic 152
bleached A2 horizon 152blow-out 33bolus 164boulders 140boundary between
horizons 199–200breakaway 33broad floristic formation 75,
95–102broad floristic
subformation 75, 77bryophyte 89buried soils 153, 156
calcrete 192–3, 219caldera 62carbonate 154, 155, 198cast 180centrifugal channel
network 52centripetal channel
network 52channel, see stream
channelchannel bench 33
channel network, see stream channel
chenier plain 62chenopod shrub 89cirque 33clay 162clay skins 182cliff 33cliffed slope 19cliff-footslope 33, 38clod 181closed depression 20coarse fragments 139–43,
170–1abundance 139–40, 141distribution 170–1lithology 142shape 142, 143size 140soil profile 170–1strength 142surface 139
coarse gravel 162coarse gravelly 140coarse sand 162coarse silt 162cobbles 140, 162coffee rock, see organic pancoherent 172, 190collapse doline 38colluvium 219colour 159colour patterns 159–61columnar structure 173, 175complexity, rainforest 109–11concrete 220condition
surface soil 189–91vegetation 120–1, 125
cone (volcanic) 38consistence 186–9
degree of plasticity 188–9stickiness 187–8
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 240 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
Index
241
strength 187type of plasticity 188
conspicuous bleach 152contour trench 132convergent channel
network 52coordinates 7–9coral reef 62core-stones 44course lines 28cover classes 81cover type 80–7cover−abundance 86–7covered plain 62–3cracking clays 152–3cracks 184, 189crater 38creep deposit 220crest 20crown type 80–7crown separation ratio 82–3cryptogam 89cryptogam surface 190cultivation pan 195cutans 182–3cut face 38cut-over surface 38
dam 38date 13datum 7–8debil-debil 130decomposed rock 220deep weathering profiles 211deflation basin 38delta 63densipan 153, 194depression 20depth
of horizons 156to free water 144to R horizon 156, 159
detrital sedimentary rocks 220
diastrophism 31disintegrated channel
network 52distributary channel
pattern 50disturbance of site 128
sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5
divergent channel network 52
dolinecollapse 38solution 42–3
drainage density 48drainage depression 38drainage height 28, 128
sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5
drainage 202–4dune 26, 38 see also barchan
dune, hummocky dune, linear or longitudinal dune, parabolic dune
dunecrest 26, 38dunefield 63duneslope 26, 38duripan 193
earth 216earth movements 31earthy pan 155effervescence 198elevation 127–8
sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5
eluvial horizon 148embankment 38emergents 79, 94–5, 115–6eolianite 220eolian sand 220eolian sediment 220erosion 133–8
accelerated 133–4gully 136–7mass movement 138natural 133rill 136sampling area for 5scald 135sheet 135–6site dimensions for 5state 134stream bank 137tunnel 137water 135–7wave 137
wind 134–5erosional stream channel 49escarpment 63–4estuary 39evaporite 220explicit use of attributes 1, 17,
45extraterrestrial agents 31, 57extremely low relief 47
fabric 181–2fan 39faunal accumulation 153fern 89, 115ferricrete 194, 221ferruginised 211field pH 198field texture 161–70
determination 163–4grade 164–6modifiers 166–7of organic soils 169–70properties affecting 167–9qualification 166–7
fill 221fill-top 39fine clay 162fine gravel 162fine gravelly 140fine sand 162fine silt 162flat 20, 22, 133flood-out 39flood plain 64floristics 75, 97–102foliage cover 80, 83
classes 81food 89footslope 39forb 89foredune 39formation 75, 80–7fragipan 155, 193fragment 181
gently inclined slope 19gently undulating 46, 47geomorphological activity
anti-gradational 29gradational 29
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 241 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
242
mode 29–30status 54–5
geomorphological agentin a landform element
30in a landform pattern 52,
54gilgai 129–30
components 130, 133depression 133mound 133shelf 133types 129–130
gleying 153glossary
growth forms 88–93landform element
types 31–44landform pattern
types 55–72substrate genetic mass
types 219–27GPS 7, 10gradational activity 29grain size
grade limits 162, 206–7granular structure 179, 180grass 89
cereals 90hummock 91other industrial 90pasture 89planted/cultivated 89tussock 93
gravel 162gravel-sized 207grid reference 8ground cover 82, 83ground truth 2growth forms
standard vegetation 88–93
rainforest vegetation 114–5
wetland vegetation 106growth stage 120
indicators 122–3gully 39gully erosion 136–7gypsum 155, 221
halite 221hard setting 190heath 90height classes,
vegetation 93–5herb, planted/cultivated 90
annual, food 90annual, non-food 90perennial, food 90perennial, non-food 90
high relief 47hillcrest 39hillock 20hills 64hillslope 39horizon boundary
distinctness 199shape 200
horizons 148–56A 149–50B 150–1bleached 152, 154boundaries 199–200buried 153, 156C 151D 151depth 156E 148eluvial 148in cracking clays 152–3O 148P 149R 151, 216subdivision 155suffixes 153–5transitional 151–2
horizontal interval 133hummock 133hummock grass 91hummocky dune 40hummocky microrelief
130–1hydraulic conductivity
(Ks) 200
igneous rocks 213, 221ignimbrite 221incipient stream channel
49incoherent 171, 190
integrated channel network 52
internal drainage 202interrupted channel
network 52intertidal flat, see tidal flatinundation 138–9
sampling area for 5site dimension for 5
ironpan 194
kaolinised 211karst 65kwongan shrub 90
lacustrine plain 65lacustrine sediment 221lagoon 40lake 40land facet 16landform 15–72landform description 15–7landform element
description 17–31dimensions 16, 17, 27genesis 28–9morphological type 19–26relative inclination 21–2sampling area for 5short description 26–7site dimensions for 5toposequence position 28types 31–44
landform patternboundaries 45characteristic
dimension 16, 17description 44–55glossary of types 55–72sampling area 5short description 46site dimension 5
landslide 40landslide deposit 222land surface 15, 127–45
sampling area 5site dimensions for 5
land system 16land unit 16large scale surveys 2
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 242 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
Index
243
laterite profiles 211latitude 9lava plain 65–6leaf size 111–3lenticular structure 178, 180levee 40level slope class 19lichen 91life form 80linear dune 40lithification front 217lithologic discontinuities 156,
157lithological type of substrate
material 209–10, 212–3location 7–11loess 222longitude 9longitudinal dune 40longitudinal dunefield 66lower slope 20, 21lower stratum 94low hills 66low relief 47low terraces, see channel
benchlunette 40
maar 40macrophyll 112, 113macropores 184–185made land 66–7mallee (tree or shrub) 91mangans 182manganiferous pan 194map
scale 9sheet number 9–10topographic sheets 9–10
mapping unitsminimum width 17
marine plain 67marine sediment 222mass movement 138massive 172meander plain 67medium sand 162mesophyll 112, 113metamorphic rocks 213, 222meteor crater 67
microphyll 112, 113microrelief 129–33
biotic 131component sampled 133contour trench 132gilgai 129–30horizontal interval 133hummocky 130–1karst 132other 132sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5vertical interval 133
mid-slope 20, 21mid-stratum 79, 84mineral composition of
substrate material 208modal slope 45–6, 47mode of geomorpho-logical
activity 29–30, 52moderately inclined slope
19montane rainforest
(Tasmanian) 119morphological type of
landform element 19–26moss 114mottles 159–61
abundance 160colour 161contrast 160distinctness of
boundaries 161size 160
mound 41mountains 67–8mudflow deposit 222myrtle beech rainforest
(Tasmanian) 119
nanophyll 112, 113National Vegetation
Information System (NVIS) 15, 74, 75
non-directional channel network 52
non-tributary channel pattern 50
non-woody plant 75, 80notophyll 112, 113
open depression 20organic pan 194organic soils 169–70ortstein 194ox-bow 41
pallid zone 211palm
fan 115feather 115
pans 192–5cementation 192continuity 195structure 195type 192–5
parabolic dune 41parabolic dunefield 68parna 222partially weathered rock 222peat 169–70pebbles 140peds
primary 180size 172–3, 174–9
pedalitycompound 180grade 171–2type 173–80
pediment 41, 68pediplain 69pedologic discontinuities 155pedologic organisation 150pedon 147peneplain 69permeability 200–2pH 198phi scale 162pit 41plain 41, 69planar escarpment 63plant
non-woody 75, 80woody 75, 80, 93
plasticitydegree 188–9type 188
plateau 69platy structure 173, 174playa 41playa plain 69–70
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 243 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
244
plutonic rocks 222poached 191polyhedral structure 173, 177porcellanite 223pores 184–5porosity of substrate
material 208precipitous slope 19prior stream 41prismatic structure 173, 175projection 8projective foliage cover 80,
81pyroclastic rocks 223
rainfall 13rainforest 91, 109–20
complexity 109–11crown cover and
height 115emergents 115–6examples 118indicator growth
forms 114–5leaf size 111–3sclerophylls in 116species 113–4 Tasmanian 116, 119–20tropical/subtropical 109–
16, 117–8rainforest tree, see tree,
rainforestred-brown hardpan 193, 223reef flat 42regolith 216relict landform 54relief 45
class 47, 48estimation 45
residual rise 42restricted soil bodies 5
sampling area for 5reticulated channel
pattern 50ridge 20, 26ridge lines 27rill erosion 136risecrest 42rises 70riseslope 42
riverine landform patterns 58, 59
rock 216rock flat 42rockland 144rock outcrop 143–4
sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5
rock platform 42rock type
classification 212–4rolling 46, 47roots 199runoff 144–5
sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5
runon 138–9rush 91
saline 191samphire shrub 91sampling area for
aggradation 5, 134aspect 5depth to free water 5disturbance 5drainage height 5elevation 5erosion 5, 134inundation 5, 134land surface 5landform element 5, 16landform pattern 5, 16microrelief 5rock outcrop 5runoff 5slope 5surface coarse
fragments 5vegetation 86, 87
sand 162sand plain 70sand-sized 207saprolite 223scald 42scald erosion 135scale
map 9mapping 16, 17
scarp 42
scarp-footslope 42sclerophyll 116scoria 210scree 223scroll 42scroll plain 42seagrass, marine 91sedge 92sedimentary rocks 212, 223
chemical and organic 219detrital 220
segregations of pedogenic origin 195–8abundance 196form 196–7magnetic attributes 198nature 196size 197strength 197–8
seismic velocity 215self-mulching 189sheet erosion 135–6sheet-flood fan 70sheet flow deposit 223shelf 133shrub 92
chenopod 89food 92heath 90kwongan 90mallee 91non-food 92samphire 91
SI units 3sieve apertures 162silcrete 224silicification 211silt 162silt-sized 207simple slope 20, 21single grain 171sinkhole 132site
attributes, importance of 2
concept 5dimensions 5disturbance 128
site dimensions foraggradation 5, 134
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 244 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
Index
245
aspect 5depth to free water 5disturbance 5drainage height 5elevation 5erosion 5, 134inundation 5, 134land surface 5landform element 5, 16landform pattern 5, 16microrelief 5rock outcrop 5runoff 5slope 5surface coarse
fragments 5vegetation 86, 87
size fractions 162slickensides 183slope 21
as a landform element attribute 17
as a type of landform element 18–9
categories 21class boundaries 19evaluation 18inclination 21–2modal, as a landform
pattern attribute 45–6sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5value 18
slope lines 20, 24, 27soil
classes 3classification 3, 225–7engineering
definition 215horizons see Horizonsparent material 151, 205properties 2
soil observation 147–8soil profile 147–204
coarse fragments in 170–1described by 13
soil structure 171–81grade 171–2size 172–3, 174–9type 173, 180
soil surveys 1soil taxonomic units 225–7
Australian Soil Classification 225–6
Soil Taxonomy 226World Reference
Base 226–7soil texture 161–70soil water regime 200–4soil water status 186solum 151solution doline 42–3species codes 96–7sporadic bleach 152spring
hollow 132mound 132
stabilised soil 224stagnant alluvial plain 70–1State or Territory 7steep slope 19sticky point 163, 188stones 140strata, vegetation 77–80stream bank 32stream bank erosion 137stream bar 32stream bed 43stream channel 43
depth relative to width 49–50
development 49frequency 48migration 50network directionality 51,
52network integration
50–2occurrence 46, 48–52, 53pattern 51spacing 48stream-wise channel
pattern 50, 51strength of substrate
materials 209stress cutans 183structural formation 75,
88–95structure
soil, see soil structure
subangular blocky structure 173, 176
subplastic 188substrate 205–24substrate masses 205
alteration 211bulk density 215genetic type 216–24mass strength 211, 216properties 210–6spacing of
discontinuities 210substrate material 205
grain size 206–7confidence, parent
material 206lithological type 209mineral composition 208point of observation 205–
6porosity 208properties 206–10strength 209structure 207–8texture 207type of observation 205–6unconsolidated
material 210, 214summit surface 43superplastic 188supratidal flat 43surface coarse
fragments 139–43sampling area for 5site dimensions for 5
surface crust 190surface flake 190surface soil condition 189–91surveys
detailed 3reconnaissance 3scale of 2
swale 43swamp 43swamp hummock 131
tallest stratum 79, 94talus 43Tasmanian rainforest 116,
119–20
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 245 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
Australian Soil and Land Survey Field Handbook
246
terrace (alluvial) 71terrace flat 43terrace plain 44terraced land (alluvial) 71terracettes 132texture
diagram 163field 161–70laboratory 161
thin ironpan 194tidal creek 44tidal flat 44, 71till 224topographic map sheets 9–10toposequence 21tor 44trampled 191tree 92
food 93landscaping 93mallee 91non-food 93rainforest 92
trench 44contour 132
tributary channel pattern 50tropical/subtropical
rainforest 109–16, 117–8tumulus 44tunnel erosion 137
tussock grass 93type of soil observation 147–
8
unconsolidated substrate materials 210, 214
undulating 47unidirectional channel
network 52units, SI specified 3upper slope 20, 21
vale 20valley flat 44vegetation 73–125
broad floristic formation 75, 95–102
condition 120–1, 125cover classes 81crown types 85emergents 79, 94–5, 115–6examples of coding 102–
5, 118, 119–20floristics 97–102formation 75, 80–7growth form 88–95, 106growth stage 120, 122–4height 93–4, 95rainforest 109–20recognising strata 77–80
site dimension 86, 87standard classification 74,
77, 102, 109structural formation 88–
95wetlands 103–9
vertical interval 133very coarse sand 162very fine sand 162very gently inclined slope
19very high relief 47very low relief 47very steep slope 19vine 93, 115voids 184volcanic ash 224volcanic rocks 224volcano 72
wallum shrub 90water erosion 135–7water repellence 191–2wave erosion 137weathering front 217wetlands 103–9
growth forms 106types 106–9
wind erosion 134–5woody plant 75, 80, 93
030806•Aust Soil and Land Survey Final.indd 246 4/02/09 12:05:32 PM
top related